Location via proxy:   [ UP ]  
[Report a bug]   [Manage cookies]                

Nasa - cr-1457 Manual For Structural Stability Analysis of Sandwitch Plates and Shells

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 404

https://ntrs.nasa.gov/search.jsp?

R=19700004831 2018-12-12T16:27:07+00:00Z

CONTRACTOR NASA CR-1457

_N A S A REPORT

_- i_ B
I

!z CASE Fi LE

MANUAL FOR STRUCTURAL


STABILITY ANALYSIS OF

I SANDWICH PLATES AND SHELLS

I by R. T. Sulli,is, G. IFC Smith, a,id E. E. Spier

i _Prepared b),
E7 :

_ GENERAL DYNAMICS CORPORATION

_:San Diego, Calif.


_r Manned Spacecraf Ce,zter

E NATIONAL AERONAUTICS AND SPACE ADMINISTRATION • WASHINGTON, D. C. • DECEMBER-1969

E_
k

_k

_____ ". _ -........ =..... -- •!

!
|
E

!
NASA CR-1457

MANUAL FOR STRUCTURAL STABILITY ANALYSIS

OF SANDWICH PLATES AND SHELLS

By R. T. Sullins, G. W. Smith, and E. E. Spier

Distribution of this report is provided in the interest of


information exchange. Responsibility for the contents
resides in the author or organization that prepared it.

Prepared under Contract No. NAS 9-8244 by


GENERAL DYNAMICS CORPORATION
San Diego, Calif.

for Manned Spacecraft Center

NATIONAL AERONAUTICS AND SPACE ADMINISTRATION

For sale by the Clearinghouse for Federal Scientific and Technical Information
Springfield, Virginia 22151 - Price $3.00
ACE

I
/

/ ttONEYCOMB..-'_'III Iil tli I _ //" //


/ _o_ _q-ll II tIL-_ / // /4

_ / /_D 1Rp_l
IBCB_]N);

CORE i
/
{

DEPTH ! / _ _t l--

RIBBON
DIRECTION

HONEYCOMB SANDWICH CONSTRUCTION

iii
ABSTRACT

The basic objective of this study was to develop and compile a manual which
would include practical and up-to-date methods for analyzing the structural
stabilityof sandwich plates and she]Is for typical loading conditions which
might be encountered in aerospace applications. The methods proposed for
use would include known analytical approaches as modified for correlation
with applicable test data.

The data presented here covers recommended design equations and curves
for a wide range of structural configurations and loading conditions, includ-
ing combined loads. In a number of cases, actual test data points are in-
cluded on the design curves to substantiate the recommendations made. For
those items where little or no test data exists the basic analytical approach
is presented along with the notation that this represented the 'best available"
data and should be used with some caution and judgment until substantiated
by test.

The following subjects are among those covered in the manual:

Local Instability

General Instability of Flat Panels

General Instability of Circular Cylinders

General Instability of Truncated Circular Cones

General Instability of Dome-Shaped Shells

Instability of Sandwich Shell Segments

Effects of Cutouts on the General Instability of Sandwich Shells

Inelastic Behavior of Sandwich Plates and Shells


TABLE OF CONTENTS

Section Page

INTRODUCTION ................. I-i

i. 1 GE 2:ERA_" ................. i-i

I. 2 FAILURE MODES ............. 1-4

LOCAL INSTABILITY ............... 2-1

2.1 INTRACELLULAR BUCKLING (Face Dimpling) 2-1

2. i. 1 Sandwich with Honeycomb Core ......... 2-1

2.1.2 Sandwich with Corrugated Core ......... 2-8

2.2 FACE WRINKLING ............. 2-21

2.2.1 Sandwich with Solid or Foam Core (Antisymmetric


Wrinkling) ................ 2-21

2.2.2 Sandwich with Honeycomb Core (Symmetric


Wrinkling) ................ 2-28

2.3 SHEAR CRIMPING ............. 2-37

2.3.1 Basic Principles ............. 2-37

2.3.2 Design Equations ............. 2 -40

GENERAL INSTABILITY OF FLAT PANELS ....... 3-1

3.1 RECTANGULAR PLATES .......... 3-1

3.1 1 General ................ 3-1

3.1 2 ITniaxial Edgewise Compression ........ 3-5

3.1 3 Edgewise Shear .............. 3-25

3.1 4 Edgewise Bending Moment .......... 3-37

3.1 5 Other Single Loading Conditions ........ 3-46

3.1 6 Combined Loading Conditions ......... 3-47

3.2 CIRCULAR PLATES ............ 3-73

3.2.1 Available Single Loading Conditions ....... 3-73

3.2.2 Available Combined Loading Conditions ...... 3-73

3.3 PLATES WITH CUTOUTS .......... 3-74

3.3.1 Framed Cutouts .............. 3-74

3.3.2 Unframed Cutouts ............. 3-75

4 GENERAL INSTABILITY OF CIRCULAR CYLINDERS .... 4-1

4.1 GENERAL ................ 4-1

4.2 AXIAL COMPRESSION ........... 4-5

4.2.1 Basic Principles ............. 4-5

4.2.2 Design Equations and Curves ......... 4-17

vii
TABLE OF CONTENTS, Cont'd.

Section Page

4.3 PURE BENDING .............. 4-25


4.3.1 Basic Principles ............. 4-25
4.3.2 Design Equations and Curves ......... 4-29
4.4 EXTERNAL LATERAL PRESSURE ....... 4-32
4.4.1 Basic Principles ............. 4-32
4.4.2 Design Equations and Curves ......... 4-42
4.5 TORSION ................ 4-47
4.5.1 Basic Principles ............. 4-47
4.5.2 Design Equations and Curves ......... 4-54
4.6 TRANSVERSE SHEAR ............ 4-62
4.6.1 Basic Principles ............. 4-62
4.6.2 Design Equations and Curves ......... 4-64
4.7 COMBINED LOADING CONDITIONS ....... 4-65
4.7.1 General ................ 4-65
4,7.2 Axial Compression Plus Bending ........ 4-67
4.7.3 Axial Compression Plus External Lateral Pressure. 4-71
4.7.4 Axial Compression Plus Torsion ........ 4-89
4.7.5 Other Loading Combinations .......... 4-95

GENERAL INSTABILITY OF TRUNCATED CIRCULAR


CONES .................... 5-1

5.1 AXIAL COMPRESSION ........... 5-1


5.1.1 Basic Principles ............. 5-1
5.1.2 Design Equations and Curves ......... 5-4
5.2 PURE BENDING .............. 5-6
5.2.1 Basic Principles ............. 5-6
5.2.2 Design Equations and Curves ......... 5-7
5.3 EXTERNAL LATERAL PRESSURE ....... 5-9
5.3.1 Basic Principles ............. 5-9
5,3.2 Design Equations and Curves ......... 5-12
5.4 TORSION ................ 5-14
5.4.1 Basic Principles ............. 5-14
5.4.2 Design Equations and Curves ......... 5-16
5.5 TRANSVERSE SHEAR ............ 5-18
5.5.1 Basic Principles ............. 5-18
5.5.2 Design Equations and Curves ......... 5-20
5.6 COMBINED LOADING CONDITIONS ....... 5-21
5.6.1 General ................ 5-21
5.6.2 Axial Compression Plus Bending ........ 5-23

viii
TABLE OF CONTENTS, Cont'd.

Section Page

5.6.3 Uniform External Hydrostatic Pressure ...... 5-27


5.6.4 Axial Compression Plus Torsion ........ 5-34
5.6.5 Other Loading Combinations .......... 5-39

GENERAL INSTABILITY OF DOME-SHAPED SHELLS .... 6-1

6.1 GENERAL ................ 6-1


6.2 EXTERNAL PRESSURE ........... 6-3
6.2.1 Basic Principles ............. 6-3

6.2.2 Design Equations and Curves ......... 6-12


6.3 OTHER LOADING CONDITIONS ........ 6-15

INSTABILITY OF SANDWICH SHELL SEGMENTS ..... 7-1

7.1 CYLINDRICAL CURVED PANELS ........ 7-1


7. i. 1 Axial Compression ............. 7-1
7.1.2 Other Loading Conditions ........... 7-11
7.2 OTHER PANEL CONFIGURATIONS ....... 7-11

EFFECTS OF CUTOUTS ON THE GENERAL INSTABILITY


OF SANDWICH SHELLS .............. 8-1

INELASTIC BEHAVIOR OF SANDWICH PLATES AND


SHE L LS 9-1

9.1 SINGLE LOADING CONDITIONS ........ 9-1


9.1.1 Basic Principles ............. 9-1
9.1.2 Design Equations ............. 9-3
9.2 COMBINED LOADING CONDITIONS ....... 9-i0
9.2.1 Basic Principles ............. 9-10
9.2.2 Suggested Method ............. 9-13

ix
LIST OF FIGURES

Figure P age

1.1-1 Typical Sandwich Construction ............ 1-2

1.2-1 Localized Instability Modes ............. 1-5

1.2-2 Ultimate Failures Precipitated by Face Wrinkling ..... 1-5

1.2-3 Non-Localized Instability Modes ........... 1-6

2.1-1 Critical Stresses for Intracellular Buckling Under


Unia.xi al Compression ............... 2-3

Definition of Dimensions .............. 2-5

Chart for Determination of Core Cell Size Such That


Intracellular Buckling Will Not Occur ......... 2-6

2.1-4 Corrugation Configurations ............. 2-8

2.1-5 Buckling Modes ................. 2-10

2.1-6 Local Buckling Coefficient for Single-Truss-Core


Sandwich ................... 2-14

2.1-7 Local Buckling Coefficient for Single-Truss-Core


Sandwich ................... 2-15

2.1-8 Local Buckling Coefficient for Single-Truss-Core


Sandwich .................. 2-16

2.1-9 Local Buckling Coefficient for Double-Truss-Core


Sandwich ................... 2-17

2.1-10 Local Buckling Coefficient for Double-Truss-Core


Sandwich ................... 2-18

2.1-11 Local Buckling Coefficient for Double-Truss-Core


Sandwich ................... 2-19

2.1-12 Local Buckling Coefficient for Truss-Core


San&rich ................... 2-20

Typical Variation of Q vs. q ............. 2-24

Comparison of Theory vs Test Results for Face Wrinkling


in Sanchvich Constructions Having Solid or Foam Cores. 2-25

2.2-3 Parameters for Determination of Face Wrinkling in


Sandwich Constructions Having Solid or Foam Cores .... 2-27

xi
LIST OF FIGURES,Cont'd.

Figure Page

2.2-4 T_3_ical
DesignCurvesfor FaceWrinklingin Sanchvich
ConstructionsHavingHoneycomb
Cores......... 2-30

2.2-5 Comparisonof Theoryvs Test Resultsfor FaceWrinkling


in SandwichConstructionsllaving HoneycombCores ..... 2-31

2.2-6 Relationship of K6 to Honeycomb Core Properties (Fc/Ee)


and Facing Waviness Parameter (6/te) .......... 2 -34

2.2-7 Graphs of Equation (2.2-12) for the Wrinkling Stress of


Facings in San_vieh Constructions ttaving ttoncycomb
Cores .................... 2-35

2.3-1 Uniaxial Compression ............... 2 -40

2.3-2 Pure Shear .................. 2-41

3.1-1 Elastic Properties and Dimensional Notations for a


Typical Sandwich Panel .............. 3-4

3.1-2 K M for a Sandwich Panel with Ends and Sides Simply


Supported, Isotropie Facings, and Orthotropie Core,
(R = 0.40) ................... 3-10

3.1-3 K M for Sanchvich Panel with Ends and Sides Simply


Supported, Isotropic Facings, and Isotropic Core,
(R = 1.00) ................... 3-11

3.1-4 K M for Sandwich Panel with Ends and Sides Simply


Supported, Isotropic Facings, and Orthotropic Core,
(R = 2.50) ................... 3-12

3.1-5 K M for Sandwich Panel with Ends Simply Supported and


Sides Clamped, Isotropic Facings, and Orthotropic Core,
(R = 0.40) ................... 3-13

3.1-6 K M for Sandwich Panel with Ends Simply Supported and


Sides Clamped, Isotropic Facings, and Isotropic Core,
(R = 1.00) ................... 3-14

3.1-7 K M for Sandwich Panel with Ends Simply Supported and


Sides Clamped, Isotropic Facings, and Orthotropic Core,
(R = 2.50) ................... 3-15

xii
LIST OF FIGURES, Cont'd.

Figure Page

3.1-8 K M for Sandwich Panel with Ends Clamped and Sides Simply
Supported, Isotropic Facings, and Orthotropic Core,
(R = 0.40) ................... 3-16

3.1-9 K M for Sandwich Panel with Ends Clamped and Sides Simply
Supported, Isotropic Facings, and Isotropic Core,
(R = 1.00) ................... 3-17

3.1-10 K M for Sandwich Panel with Ends Clamped and Sides Simply
Supported, Isotropic Facings, and Orthotropic Core,
(R = 2.50) ................... 3-18

3.1-11 K M for Sandwich Panel with Ends and Sides Clamped,


Isotropic Facings, and Orthotropic Core, (R = 0.40) .... 3-19

3.1-12 K M for Sandwich Panel with Ends and Sides Clamped,


Isotropic Facings, and Isotropic Core, (R = 1.00) ..... 3-20

3.1-13 K M for Sandwich Panel with Ends and Sides Clamped,


Isotropic Facings, and Orthotropic Core, (R = 2.50) .... 3-21

3.1-14 K M for Simply Supported Sandwich Panel Having a


Corrugated Core. Core Corrugation Flutes are
Perpendicular to the Load Direction .......... 3-22

3.1-15 K M for Simply Supported Sandwich Panel Having a


Corrugated Core. Core Corrugation Flutes are
Parallel to the Load Direction ............ 3-23

3.1-16 KM o for Sandwich Panel With Isotropic Facings in


Edgewise Compression .............. 3-24

3.1-17 K M for a Sandwich Panel with All Edges Simply Supported,


and an Isotropic Core, (R = 1.00) ........... 3-29

3.1-18 K M for a Sandwich Panel with All Edges Simply Supported,


and an Orthotropic Core, (R = 2.50) .......... 3-30

3.1-19 K M for a Sandwich Panel with All Edges Simply Supported,


and with an Orthotropic Core, (R = 0.40) ........ 3-31

3.1-20 K M for a Sandwich Panel with All Edges Simply Supported,


Isotropic Facings and Corrugated Core. Core Corrugation
Flutes are Parallel to Side a ............ 3-32

xiii
LIST OF FIGURES, Cont'd.

Figure Page

3.1-21 K M for a Sandwich Panel with All Edges Simt)ly Supported,


Isotropic Facings and Corrugated Core. Core Corrugation
Flutes are Parallel to Side b ............ 3-33

3.1-2'2 K M for a Sanchvich Panel with All Edges Clamped, Isotropic


Facings and Isotropic Core, (It = 1.00) ......... 3-34

"5.1-23 K M for a Sandwich Panel with All Edges Clamped, Isotropic


Facings and Orthotropie Core, (R = 2.50) ........ 3-35

3.1-24 K M for a Sanchvich Panel with All Edges Clamped, Isotropie


Facings and Orthotropic Core, (R = 0.40) ........ 3-36

3.1-25 K M for a Simply Supported Sanchvich Panel with an Isotropic


Core, (R - 1.00) ................ 3-42

3.1-26 K M for a Simply Supporled Sandwich Panel with an Orthotropic


Core, (H = 2.50) ................ 3-43

3 1-27 K M [or a Simply Supported San(kvich Panel with an Orthotropie


Core, (R = 0.40) ................ 3 -44

3 1-28 K M for a Simply Supported Sanchvieh Panel with Corrugated


Core. Core Corrugation Flutes Parallel In Side a ..... 3-45

3 1-29 Interacti,m Curve for a Honeycomb Core Sanchvich Panel

Subjected to Bimxial Compression ........... 3-59

3 1-30 Interaction Curve for a tloneyeomb Core Sandwich Panel

Subjected to Bending and Compression ......... 3-60

3 1-31 Interaction Curve for a Itoneyeomb Core Sand_vich Panel


Subjected to Compression and Shear .......... 3-61

3 1-32 Interaction Curve for a Honeycomb Core Sandwich Panel


Subjected to Bending and Shear ............ 3-62

,,'). 1-33 Buckling Coefficients for Corrugated Core Sandwich Panels


in Biaxial Compression (a/b = 1/2) .......... 3-63

3 1-34 Buckling Coefficients for Corrugated Core Sandwich Panels


in Biaxial Compression (a/b = 1.0) .......... 3-64

3.1-35 Buckling Coefficients for Corrugated Core Sandwich Panels


in Biaxial Compression (a/b = 2.0) .......... 3-65

xiv
LISTOF FIGURES,Cont'd.

Figure Page

3.1-36 Buckling Coefficients for Corrugated Core Sandwich Panels


Under Combined Longitudinal Compresmon and Shear with
3-66
Longitudinal Core (a/b = 1/2) ..........

3.1-37 Buckling Coefficients for Corrugated Core Sandwich Panels


Under Combined Longitudinal Compression and Shear with
Longitudinal Core (a/b = 1.0) .......... 3-67

3.1-38 Buckling Coefficients for Corrugated Core Sandwich Panels


Under Combined Longitudinal Compresmon and Shear with
Longitudinal Core (a/b = 2.0) .......... 3-68

3.1-39 Buckling Coefficients for Corrugated Core Sandwich Panels


Under Combined Longitudinal Compresmon and Shear with
Transverse Core (a/b = 1/2) .......... 3-69

3.1-40 Buckling Coefficients for Corrugated Core Sandwich Panels


Under Combined Longitudinal Compressloh and Shear with
Transverse Core (a/b = 1.0) .......... 3-70

3.1-41 Buckling Coefficients for Corrugated Core Sandwich Panels


Under Combined Longitudinal Compression and Shear with
3-71
Transverse Core (a/b = 2.0) ..........

3.1-42 Buckling Coefficients for Corrugated Core Sandwich Panels


Under Combined Longitudinal Compresmon, Transverse
3-72
Compression, and Shear with Longitudinal Core ......

4.1-1 Equilibrium Paths for Axially Compressed Circular


Cylinders ...................

Typical Equilibrium Paths for Circular Cylinders .....

Schematic Representation of Relationship Between K c and


V for 0 _ 1 .................. 4-7
C

4.2-2 Semi-Logarithmic Plot of _/c vs R/t' for Isotropic (Non-


4-9
Sandwich) Cylinders Under Axial Compression ......

4.2-3 Knock-Down Factor 3Zc for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


Subjected to Axial Compression ........... 4-10

4.2-4 Comparison of Proposed Design Criterion Against Test


Data for Weak-Core Circular Sandwich Cylinders Sub-

jected to Axial Compression ............. 4-12

XV
LIST OF FIGURES, Cont'd.

Figure Page

4.2-5 Comparison of Proposed Design Criterion Against a Test


Result for a Weak-Core Circular Sandwich Cylinder
4-13
Subjected to Axial Compression ...........

Stresses Involved in Interpretation of Test Data ...... 4-15

Buckling Coefficient for Axially Compressed Circular


Sandwich Cylinders ................ _-19

4.2-8 Design Knock-Down Factor for Circular Sandwich


4-20
Cylinders Subjected to Axial Compression ........

4.2-9 Buckling Coefficient for Short Simply-Supported Sandwich


Cylinders Subjected to Axial Compression (0 = 1) ...... 4-24

4.3-1 Knock-Down Factor _o for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


4-28
Subjected to Pure Bending ...........

4.3-2 Design Knock-Down Factor Mo for Circular Sandwich


4-30
Cylinders Subjected to Pure Bending ..........

4.4-1 Circular Sandwich Cylinder Subjected to External


Lateral Pressure .............. 4-32

4.4-2 Schematic Representation of Log-Log Plot of Cp Versus


L/R for Circular Sandwich Cylinders Subjected to
External Lateral Pressure ............. 4-36

4.4-3 Buckling Coefficients Cp for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


Subjected to External Lateral Pressure; Isotropic Facings;
Transverse Shear Properties of Core Isotropie or Ortho-
4-44
tropic; Vp = 0 .................

4.4-4 Buckling Coefficients Cp for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


Subjected to External Lateral Pressure; Isotropic Facings;
Transverse Shear Properties of Core Isotropic or Ortho-
4-45
tropic; Vp = 0.05 ................

4.4-5 Buckling Coefficients Cp for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


Subjected to External Lateral Pressure; Isotropic Facings;
Transverse Shear Properties of Core Isotropic or Ortho-
4-46
tropic; Vp = 0.10 ...............

4.5-1 Circular Sandwich Cylinder Subjected to Torsion ...... 4-47

xvi
LIST OF FIGURES, Cont'd.

Page
Figure

4.5-2 Typical Log-Log Plot of the Buckling Coefficient K s for


4-50
Circular Sandwich Cylinders Subjected to Torsion .....

4.5-3 Buckling Coefficients for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


4-56
Subjected to Torsion ...............

4.5-4 Buckling Coefficients for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


4-57
Subjected to Torsion ...............

4.5-5 Buckling Coefficients for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


4-58
Subjected to Torsion ...............

4.5-6 Buckling Coefficients for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


4-59
Subjected to Torsion ...............

4.5-7 Buckling Coefficients for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


4-60
Subjected to Torsion ...............

4.5-8 Buckling Coefficients for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


4-61
Subjected to Torsion ...............
4-66
Sample Interaction Curve ..............

Design Interaction Curve for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


4-68
Subjected to Axial Compression Plus Bending .......

4.7-3 Design Interaction Curve for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


4-70
Subjected to Axial Compression Plus Bending .......

4.7-4 Circular Sandwich Cylinder Subjected to Axial Compression


Plus External Lateral Pressure .......... 4-71

4.7-5 Typical Interaction Curves for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


Subjected to Axial Compression Plus External Lateral
4-74
Pressure ...................

4.7-6 Interaction Curves for Circular Sandwich Cylinders Subjected


4-79
to Axial Compression Plus External Lateral Pressure ....

4.7-7 Interaction Curves for Circular Sandwich Cylinders Subjected


to Axial Compression Plus External Lateral Pressure .... 4-80

4.7-8 Interaction Curve for Circular Sandwich Cylinders Subjected


4-81
to Axial Compression Plus External Lateral Pressure ....

4.7-9 Interaction Curves for Circular Sandwich Cylinders Subjected


4-82
to Axial Compression Plus External Lateral Pressure ....

xvii
LIST OF FIGURES, Cont'd.

Figure Page

4.7-10 Interaction Curves for Circular Sandwich Cylinders Subjected


to Axial Compresmon Plus External Lateral Pressure .... 4-83

4.7-11 Interaction Curves for Circular Sandwich Cylinders Subjected


to Axial Compress:on Plus External Lateral Pressure .... 4-84

4.7-12 Interaction Curves for Circular Sandwich Cylinders Subjected


to Axial Con:press:on Plus External Lateral Pressure .... 4-85

4.7-13 Interaction Curves for Circular Sandwich Cylinders Subjected


to Axial Con:press:on Plus External Lateral Pressure .... 4-86

4.7-14 Interaction Curves for Circular Sandwich Cylinders Subjected


to Axial Compresmon Plus External Lateral Pressure .... 4-87

4.7-15 Interaction C_rves for Circular Sandwich Cylinders Subjected


to Axial Compresswn Plus External Lateral Pressure .... 4-88

4.7-16 Circular Sandwich Cylinder Subjected to Axial Compression


Plus Torsion .................. 4-89

4.7-17 Conditional Interaction Curve for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


Subjected to Axial Compression Plus Torsion ....... 4-93
4.7-18 Conservative Interaction Curve for Circular Sandwich Cylinders
Subjected to Axial Compression Plus Torsion ....... 4-94
5.1-1 Empirical Knock-Down Factors ........... 5-2
5.1-2 Truncated Sandwich Cone Subjected to Axial Compression. 5-4
5.2-1 Truncated Sandwich Cone Subjected to Pure Bending ..... 5-7
5.3-1 Truncated Cone Subjected to Uniform External Lateral
Pressure • , • . • o . , . . . , . . . o . • . 5-9
5.3-2 Truncated Sandwich Cone .............. 5-12
5.4-1 Truncated Sandwich Cone Subjected to Torsion ...... 5-17
5.5-1 Truncated Cone Subjected to Transverse Shear ...... 5-18
5.6-1 Sample Interaction Curve .............. 5-21
5.6-2 Design Interaction Curve for Truncated Sandwich Cones
Subjected to Axial Compression Plus Bending ....... 5-26

XVIII
LIST OF FIGURES, Cont'd.

Figure P age

5.6-3 Truncated Cone Subjected to Uniform External Hydrostatic


Pressure ................... 5-27

Truncated Sandwich Cone .............. 5-31

Truncated Cone Subjected to Axial Compression Plus


Torsion ................... 5-34

5.6-6 Conditional Interaction Curve for Truncated Sandwich


Cones Subjected to Axial Compression Plus Torsion ..... 5-38

5.6-7 Conservative Interaction Curve for Truncated Sandwich


Cones Subjected to Axial Compression Plus Torsion ..... 5-39

5.6-8 Truncated Cone Subjected to Axial Compression Plus


5--40
Bending Plus Torsion .............

6.1-1 Structural Dome Shapes .............. 6-1

6.2-1 Sanchvich Dome Subjected to External Pressure ...... 6-3

6.2-2 Schematic Representation of Relationship Between Kc and V c. 6-7

6.2-3 Knock-Down Factor 7d for Sandwich Domes Subjected to


Uniform External Pressure ............. 6-9

6.2-4 Buckling Coefficient for Sandwich Domes Subjected to


External Pressure ............... 6-13

Cylindrical Panel and Associated Flat-Plate Configuration 7-2

Schematic Logarithmic Plot of Schapitz Criterion for Non-


Sandwich Cylindrical Skin Panels ........... 7-3

7.1-3 Schematic Logarithmic Plot of Test Data for Cylindrical


Isotropic (Non-Sandwich) Skin Panels Under Axial
Compression ................ 7-6

7.1--4 Graphical Representation of Equations (7.1-5) through


7-10
(7,1-8) ....................

xix
LIST OF TABLES

Table Page
2-1 Summaryof DesignEquationsfor Local Instability Modes
of Failure ................... 2-42
3'1 Summaryof DesignEquationsfor GeneralInstability of
Flat SandwichPanels ............... 3-76
4-1 Summaryof DesignEquationsfor Instability of Circular
Cylinders ................... 4-98
5-1 Summaryof DesignEquationsfor Instability of Truncated
Circular Cones................. 5-42
6-1 Summaryof DesignEquationsfor Instability of Dome-
ShapedShells.................. 6-16
7-1 Summaryof DesignEquationsfor Instability of Cylindrical,
CurvedPanels ................. 7-12
9-1 Recommended Plasticity ReductionFactorsfor Local
Instability Modes ................ 9-7
9-2 Recommended Plasticity ReductionFactorsfor the General
Instability of Flat SanchvichPlates........... 9-8
9-3 Reeommended Plasticity ReductionFactorsfor the General
Instability of Circular SandwichCylinders, Truncated
Circular SandwichCones,andAxisymmetricSandwich
Domes.................... 9-9

XX
LIST OF SYMBOLS

Panel length, inches. Major semi-axis of an ellipse, inches.

a Axial length of a cylindrical panel, inches.


R

a Length of the fiat panel shown in Figure 7. I-i, inches.


P

b Panel width, inches. Minor semi-axis of an ellipse, inches.

b Circumferential width of a cylindrical panel, inches.


R

bf Pitch of corrugated core, inches.

b Width of the flat panel shown in Figure 7. i-i, inches.


P

C Length parameter defined by Equation (4.7-25), dimensionless.


L

C Parameter defined by Equations (4.2-21) and (6.2-19), dimensionless.


O

C Buckling coefficient for sandwich cylinders subjected to external


P
lateral pressure, dimensionless.

_(Elt 1) (E2t2)h2
D Bending stiffness of sandwich wall or panel =
inch-lbs. )'(Eltl + E2t2)

D Shear stiffness of sandwich wall or panel = h2(G )/t , lb/inch.


q XZ C

d
Total thickness of sandwich wall or panel (d = t 1 + t2 + tc), inches.

Young's modulus, psi.

E Young's modulus of the core in the direction normal to the facings,


C
psi.

Young's modulus of facing, psi.


Ef

E Secant modulus of facing, psi.


S

Et Tangent modulus of facing, psi.

xxi
E 1, E 2 Young's moduli for facings I and 2 respectively, psi.

e Strain intensity defined by Equation (9.2-2), in./in.


i

F Transverse shear force, Ibs.


V

(Fv) Critical transverse shear force, ibs.


cr

F Flatwise sandwich strength (the 10wcr of flatwise core compressive,


C
flatwise core tensile, and flatwise core-to-facing bond strengths),
psi.

G Transverse shear modulus of core, psi.


e

G Core shear modulus associated with the plane perpendicular to the


ca
facings and parallel to side a of panel, psi.

Gcb Core shear modulus associated with the plane perpendicular to the
facings and parallel to side b of panel, psi.

Gf Elastic shear modulus of facing, psi.

G.. Core shear modulus associated with the plane perpendicular to the
lj
facings and parallel to the direction of loading, psi.

G Secant shear modulus of facing, psi.


S

G Core shear modulus associated with the plane perpendicular to the


XZ
facings and parallel to the axis of revolution of a cylinder, psi.

G Core shear modulus associated with the plane perpendicular to the


yz
axis of revolution of a cylinder, psi.

h Distance between middle surfaces of the two facings of a sandwich


construction, inches.

K Buckling coefficient for an isotropic (non-sandwich) flat plate,

dimensionless. Buckling coefficient for fiat rectangular sandwich

pane] under edgewise compression (Kc) , edgewise shear (Ks) , or

edgewise bending (Eb). K = KF + KM.

K Theoretical flat panel buckling coefficient which is dependent on


F
facing stiffness and panel aspect ratio, dimensionless.

xxii
K Theoretical fiat panel buckling coefficient which is dependent on
M sandwich bending and shear rigidities, panel aspect ralio, and

applied loading, dimensionless.

K Buckling coefficient for sandwich cylinders under axial compression


C
and sandwich domes under external pressure, dimenionlcss.

K I Buckling coefficient for short sandwich cylinders under axial com-


c
pression, dimensionless.

K Parameter defined by Equation (4.4-2), dimensionless.


P

K Buckling coefficient for sandwich cylinder subjected to torsion,


S
dimensionless.

K Parameter defined by Equation (2.2-4), dimensionless.


5

Buckling coefficient, dimensionless.

k Buckling coefficient associated with compressive stress acting in


X
the x direction, dimensionless.

Loading coefficient for applied compressive stress which is acting


X
in the x direction, dimensionless.

k Buckling coefficient associated with compressive stress acting in the


Y
y direction, dimensionless.

k I Loading coefficient for applied compressive stress which is acting in


Y
the y direction, dimensionless.

L Over-all length, inches.

L Effective length, inches.


e

M Applied bending moment, in-lbs.

M Critical bending moment, in-lbs.


cr

M. S. Margin of safety, dimensionless.

N Critical compressive running load, lbs/inch.


cr

Number of circumferential full-waves in the buckle pattern,


dimensionless.

xxiii
P Axial load, lbs.

pl Equivalent axial load defined by Equation (5.6-32), lbs.

p Critical axial load, lbs.


cr

Empirical lower-bound value for critical axial load when acting


(Per) Empirical alone, ibs.

P External pressure, psi.

P Critical value for external pressure, psi.


cr

Experimental value for critical external pressure, psi.


(Pc r ) Te st

Classical theoretical critical pressure for a cylinder subjected to


(P×tCL external pressure acting only on the end closures, psi.

External pressure acting only on the lateral surface of a cylinder,


Py
psi.

Classical theoretical critical pressure for a cylinder subjected to


(PY)cL
external pressure acting only on the lateral surface, psi.

Q The relative minimum, with respect to {, of expression (2.2-2),


dimensionless.

q Quantity defined by Equation (2.2-3), dimensionless.

R Degree of core shear modulus orthotropicity = G /G _,


dimensionless. Radius to middle surface, inehee, a CD

Stress ratio defined by Equation (4.7-9), dimensionless.

Stress ratio defined by Equation (4.7-5), dimensionless.


(Rb)cL

R Load, stress, or pressure ratios as defined in appropriate sections


C
of this handbook, dimensionless.

(Re) Stress ratios as defined in appropriate sections of this handbook,


CL dimensionless.

R Effective radius, inches.


e

xxiv
R.
Stress or load ratio for the particular type of loading associated with
1
the subscript i, dimensionless.

R Stress or load ratio for the particular type of loading associated with
J
the subscript j, dimensionless.

Radius to middle surface at the large end of a truncated conical shell,


Rlarge
measured perpendicular to the axis of revolution, inches.

R Maxium radius of curvature for middle surface of a dome-shaped


Max
shell, inches.

R Pressure ratios as defined in appropriate sections of this handbook,


P dimensionless.

Pressure ratio defined by Equation (4.7-15), dimensionless.


CL
R Load or stress ratios as defined in appropriate sections of this
s
handbook, dimensionless.

Stress ratio defined by Equation (4.7-29), dimensionless.


(Rs)cL

R Radius to middle surface at the small end of a truncated conical shell,


small
measured perpendicular to the axis of revolution, inches.

R Stress or load ratio corresponding to the x direction, dimensionless.


x

R stress or load ratio corresponding to the y direction, dimensionless.


Y

R Middle-surface radius of curvature in the plane perpendicular to the


2
meridian, inches.

r Parameter defined by Equation (4.2-37), dimensionless.


a

Cell size of honeycomb core, inches.

T External torque, in-lbs.

T Critical external torque, in-lbs.


er

(¥cr) Empirical lower-bound value for critical torque when acting alone,
Empirical in-lbs.

t Thickness, inches.

xxv
t Total thickness of the cylindrical panel shown in Figure 7.1-1, inches.
R

t Thickness of core (measured in the direction narmal to the facings),


e
inches.

t Thickness of a single facing, inches.


f

t Total thickness of the fiat panel shown in Figure 7.1-1, inches.


P

t Thickness of material from which corrugated core is formed, inches.


0

Thicknesses of the respective facings of a sandwich construction


t 1, t 2
(there is no preference as to which facing is denoted by the subscript
1 or 2), inches.
h2
U Sandwich transverse shear stiffness, defined as U = T-- Ge _ hGe'
lbs. per inch. e

2
lr D
_7 Bending and shear rigidity parameter which is defined as V -
dimensionless, b2U

Parameter defined in Sections 4.2 and 6.2, dimensionless.


C

_T Parameter defined by Equation (4.4-4), dimensionless.


P

_7 Parameter defined by Equation (4.5-4), dimensionless.


S

V Parameter defined by Equation (4.7-13), dimensionless.


XZ

V Parameter defined by Equation (4.7-14), dimensionless.


yz

W Bending and shear rigidity parameter for fiat sandwich panels with

?T2tc (Eltl)(E2t2) T?
corrugated core which is defined as W
dimensionless. Xb 2 Gcb(Eltl+E2t2 )

W Running compression load, lbs/inch.


C

z Length parameter defined by Equation (4.2-33), dimensionless.

z Length parameter defined by Equation (4.5-3), dimensionless.


S

xxvi
Angle of rotation at appropriate joint in corrugated-core sanchvich
construction (sec Figure 2.1-5), degrees. Vertex half-angle of
conical shell, degrees.

Angle of rotation at appropriate joint in corrugated-core sandwich


construction (see Figure 2.1-5), degrees.

7 Knock-down factor, dimensionless. Ratio = _y/a x, dimensionless.

Knock-down /actor associated with general instability under pure


bending, dimensionless.

Knock-down factor associated with general instability under axial


"Ye
compression, dimensionless.

Knock-down factor associated with the general instability of a dome-


Td
shaped shell under external pressure, dimensionless.

Knock-down factor determined from a test specimen subjected to the


(Ti)Test
loading condition corresponding to the subscript i, dimensionless.

Knock-down factor associated with general instability of a cylinder


under uniform external lateral pressure, dimensionless.

Knock-down factor associated with general instability under pure


torsion, dimensionless.

Amplitude of initial waviness in facing, inches.

E Normal strain in the x direction, in/in.


x

E Normal strain in the y direction, in/in.


Y

E Shear strain in the xy plane, in/in.


xy

Parameter involving the core elastic moduli, core thickness, and


buckle wavelength, dimensionless.

Plasticity reduction factor, dimensionless.

Plasticity reduction factor corresponding to an experimental critical


_Test
stress value, dimensionless.

(1 - PaPb ) = (1 - p_) for isotropic facings, dimensionless. Ratio =

r/_×, dimensionless.
xxvii
Ratio of transverse shear moduli of core Esee Equation (4.2-1)],
dimensionless.

Actual Poisson's ratio of facing, dimensionless.

v Elastic Poisson's ratio of facing, dimensionless.


e

Radius of gyration for shell wall of sandwich and non-sandwich


constructions (p _ h/2 for sandwich constructions whose two
facings are of equal thickness), inches.

(l Stress, psi.

_b Peak compressive stress due solely to an applied bending moment,


psi.

Classical theoretical value for the critical peak compressive stress


((_b)c L
under a bending moment acting alone, psi.

_CL Classical value of critical stress, psi.

c Uniform compressive stress due solely to an applied axial load,


psi.

(_!
e Effective compressive stress defined by Equation (4.7-38), psi.

Peak axial compressive stress due solely to an applied bending


((_c)b
moment, psi.

(%) Uniform axial compressive stress due solely to an applied axial


c load, psi.

(_c)CL Classical theoretical value for the critical uniform compressive


stress under an axial load acting alone, psi.

(Y Critical stress, psi.


cr

cr Experimental critical stress obtained from a particular test speci-


test men, psi.

!
(I
cr Ex_perimental critical stress which would have been attained had
test the test specimen remained elastic, psi.

xxviii
ff Critical value for the compressive stress acting in the x direction,
cr
x psi.

Compressive stresses in facings 1 and 2, respectively, in the pres-


ence of the critical loading for general instability (there is no prefer-
ence as to which facing is denoted by the subscript 1 or 2), psi.

Uniaxial compressive stress at which shear crimping occurs in sand-


crimp
wich constructions, psi.

Stress intensity defined by Equation (9.2-1), psi.


1

a ttoop membrane stress, psi.


H

Meridional membrane stress, psi.


M

Maximum possible critical stress corresponding to a particular


{YMax
material, psi.

Minimum value of stress for the post-buckling equilibrium path, psi.


O'MI N

Predicted value for critical stress, psi.


predicted

o" Critical buckling stress for a flat plate, psi.


P

Critical buckling stress for a complete cylinder, psi.


a R

(y Facing wrinkling stress, psi.


wr

(y Stress acting in the x direction, psi. Uniform axial compressive


X
stress due to an applied axial load, psi.

0 -I Effective compressive stress defined by Equation (4.7-37), psi.


X

(ax) Peak axial compressive stress due solely to an applied bending


b moment, psi.

Classical theoretical value for critical uniform axial compressive


CL stress when acting alone, psi.

(z x) Uniform axial compressive stress due solely to an applied axial


C load, psi.

Stress acting in the y direction, psi.


Y

xxix
T Shear stress, psi.

I
T Effective shear stress defined by Equation (4.7-39), psi.

Classical theoretical value for critical uniform shear stress when


(T)C L
acting alone, psi.

T Critical shear stress, psi.


cr

I
T Critical shear stress for an equivalent cylinder subjected to an
cr
applied torque, psi.

T Pure shear stress, acting coplanar with the facings, at which shear
crimp
crimping occurs in sandwich constructions, psi.

Uniform shear stress due solely to an applied torque, psi.


TT

Peak shear stress due solely to an applied transverse shear force,


T V
psi.

Angular dimension of corrugated core (see Figure 2.1-4), degrees.


Quantity defined by Equation (4.2-10), dimensionless.

Angle of rotation at appropriate joint in corrugated-core sandwich


construction (see Figure 2.1-5), degrees. Parameter defined by
Equation (4.4-3), dimensionless.

XXX
CONVERSION OF U.S. CUSTOMARY UNITS TO THE
INTERNATIONAL SYSTEM OF UNITS 1

(Reference: MIL-HDBK-23)

U.S. Customary Conversion


Quantity Unit Factor 2 SI Unit

lbm/in. 27.68 × 103 kilograms/meter3 (kg/m33)


Density
lbm/ff 3 16.02 kilograms/meter ;_ (kg/m)

meters (m)
Length ft 0.304854
in. 0.02 meters (m)

Stress psi 6. 895 x 103 newtons/meter 2 (N/m 2)

lb/in. 6. 895 x 103 newtons/meter 2 (N/m 2)


Pressure
lb/ft 2 47.88 newtons/meter 2 (N/m 2)

3
IElastieity psi 6. 895 x 10 newtons/meter 2 (N/m 2)
Moduli _ Rigidity

Tempe r atu re (° F + 460) 5/9 degrees Kelvin (°K)

The rmal conductivity Btu in./hr ft 2 ° F 0. 1240 kg cal/hr m °C

Prefixes to indicate multiples of units are as follows:

Prefix Multiple

giga (G) 109

mcga (M) 10 6

kilo (k) 103


-3
milli (m) 10

micro _) 10 -6

1
The International System of Units [Syste'me International (S1)] was adopted by the
Eleventh General Conference on Weights and Measures, Paris, October 1960, in
Resolution No. 12.

2
Multiply value given in U.S. Customary Unit by conversion factor to obtain
equivalent value in SI unit.

xxxi
1
INTRODUCTION

]. 1 GENERAL

This handbook presents practical methods for the structural stabilityanalysis of

sandwich plates and shells. The configurations and loading conditions covered here

are those which are like]y to be encountered in aerospace applications. Basic equa-

tions, design curves, and comparisons of theory against test data are included.

For the purposes of this handbook, a structural sandwich is defined as a layered

construction formed by bonding two thin facings to a comparatively thick core as

depicted in Figure 1.1-1. The facings provide practically all of the over-all bending

and in-plane extensional rigidity to the sandwich. The core serves to position the

faces at locations removed from the neutral axis, provides virtually all of the trans-

verse shear rigidity of the sandwich, and stabilizes the facings against local buckling.

Thus the structural sandwich concept is quite similar to that of a conventional I

beam. The sandwich core plays a role which is analogous to that of the I beam web

while the sandwich facings perform a function very much like that of the I beam

flanges. The primary difference between these two types of construction lies in the

Numbers in brackets [ ] in the text denote references listed at end of each major
section (1; 2; etc.).

1-1
fact that the transverse shear deflections are usually significant to the sandwich

behavior; whereas, for I beams, these deflections are only important for the special

case of relatively short, deep beams.

FACING"
J

Figure 1.1-1. Typical Sandwich Construction

The sandwich is an attractive structural design concept since, by the proper choice

of materials and geometry, constructions having high ratios of stiffness-to-weight

can be achieved. Since rigidity is required to prevent structural instability, the

sandwich is particularly well suited to applications where the loading conditions are

conducive to buckling.

The use of sandwich construction in aerospace vehicles is certainly not a recent

innovation. The British de Havilland Mosquito bomber of World War II employed

1-2
structural sandwich throughout the airframe. In this case, the sandwich was in the

form of birch face sheets bonded to a balsa wood core. Many other airplanes, includ-

ing the B-58, B-70, F-Ill, C-5A, etc., have taken advantage of the high strength-to-

weight ratio enjoyed by sandwich construction. Space vehicle applications have

included the Apollo spacecraft, the Spacecraft LM Adapter (SLA) fairings on the

Centaur and other launch vehicles, as well as propellant tank bulkheads.

In view of the ever increasing application of structural sandwich, it has become desir-

able to assemble a handbook which presents latest design and analysis criteria for the

stability of such construction. The practicing designer and stress analyst need this

information in a form suitable for easy, rapid use. This document is meant to fulfill

that need. However, it should be kept in mind that, in many areas, all practical

problems have not yet been fully resolved and one can only employ what might be re-

ferred to as a "best-available" approach. In these cases it is advisable to supplement

numerical computations with suitable testing. Such areas of uncertainty are identified

in this handbook in the sections dealing with the appropriate configurations and loading

conditions.

In the sections to follow a discussion is given of the basic principles behind the design

equations along with conclusions derived from an analysis of available test data. This

is followed by the design equations along with any limitations on their use. Also, to

facilitate their use, a table of these equations and restrictions immediately precedes

the list of references in Sections 2, 3, 4, and 5 since these sections cover a wide

range of loading conditions and considerations.

1-3
1.2 FAILURE MODES

Structuralinstability of a sandwichconstructioncanmanifestitself in a numberof

different modes. Thevariouspossibilities are as describedbelowandas shownin

Figures1.2-1 through1.2-3.

Intracellular Buckling (Face Dimpling) - This is a localized mode of instability

which occurs only when the core is not continuous. As depicted in Figure 1.2-1, in

the regions directly above core cells (such as those of a honeycomb core), the

facings buckle in plate-like fashion with the cell walls acting as edge supports. The

progressive growth of these buckles can eventually precipitate the buckling mode

identified below as face wrinkling.

Face Wrinkling - This is a localized mode of instability which manifests itself in the

form of short wavelengths in the facings, is not confined to individual cells of

cellular-type cores, and involves the transverse (normal to facings) straining of the

core material. As shown in Figure 1.2-1, one must consider the possible occurrence

of wrinkles which may be either symmetrical or antisymmetrical with respect to the

middle surface of the original undeformed sandwich. As shown in Figure 1.2-2,

final failure from wrinkling will usually result either from crushing of the core,

tensile rupture of the core, or tensile rupture of the core-to-facing bond. However,

if proper care is exercised in the selection of the adhesive system, one can reason-

ably assume that the tensile bond strength will exceed both the tensile and com-

pressive strengths of the core proper.

1-4
A - Intraceilular Buckling (Face Dimpling)

SYMMETRIC ANTISYMMETRIC

B - Face Wrinkling

C - Shear Crimping

Figure 1°2-1, Localized Instability Modes

A - Core Crushing

B - TensileRupture C - Tensile Rupture


of Bond of Core Proper

Figure 1.2-2. Ultimate Failures Precipitated by Face Wrinkling

1-5
i
,ut|

,.,_|

"_Sl

I
.mm_'

..--m_

D"--'4

L_
C

o=
Z

4_

1-6
Shear Crimping - Shear crimping is often referred to as a local mode of failure but

is actually a special form of general instability for which the buckle wavelength is

very short due to a low transverse shear modulus for the core. This phenomenon

occurs quite suddenly and usually causes the core to fail in shear; however, it may

also cause a shear failure in the core-to-facing bond. Crimping will sometimes

occur in cases where relatively long-wave general instability first develops. In such

instances the crimp appears because of severe local transverse shear stresses at

the ends of buckle patterns. As the crimp develops, the general buckle may dis-

appear and a post-test examination would then lead to an erroneous conclusion as to

the mechanism which initiated failure.

General Instability - For configurations having no supplementary stiffening (such as

rings) except at the boundaries, the general instability mode is depicted in Figure

1.2-3A. The phenomenon involves over-all bending of the composite wall coupled

with transverse (normal to facings) shear deformations. Usually, transverse exten-

sional strains do not play a significant role in this behavior. Whereas intracellular

buckling and wrinkling are localized phenomena, general instability is of a more

gross nature. Except for the special case cited under the identification "Shear

Crimping", the wavelengths associated with general instability are normally con-

siderably larger than those encountered in intracellular buckling and face wrinkling.

For configurations having supplementary stiffening at locations other than the bound-

aries, the term general instability takes on new significance and reference is also

made to an additional mode identified as panel instability. For this case, general

1-7
instability is as definedabovebut with the addedprovisionthat thebucklepattern

involvessimultaneousradial displacementof boththe sandwichwall andthe inter-

mediatestiffeners. As shownin Figure 1.2-3B, the appropriatehalf-wavelength


of

thebucklepatternmustthereforeexceedthe spacingbetweenintermediatestiffeners.

Theexampleusedin Figure 1.2-3B is thatof a sandwichcylinder stiffenedby a

seriesof rings whichhaveinsufficientstiffnessto enforcenodalpointsat their re-

spectivelocations.

Panel Instability - This mode of instability applies only to configurations which have

supplementary stiffening at locations other than the boundaries. Figure 1.2-3C

depicts this mode by again using the example of a sandwich cylinder stiffened by a

series of rings. However, in this case the rings have sufficient stiffness to enforce

nodal points at their respective locations. The rings experience no radial deforma-

tion. Therefore, the half-wavelength of the buckle pattern cannot exceed the spacing

between rings. As in the case of general instability, this mode involves over-all

bending of the composite wall coupled with transverse shear deformations. Here

again, transverse extensional strains do not play a significant role in the behavior.

1-8
2
LOCAL INSTABILITY

2.1 INTRACELLULAR BUCKLING (Face Dimpling)

2.1.1 Sandwich with Honeycomb Core

2.1.1.1 Basic Principles

From a practical viewpoint, intracellular buckling can be regarded as flat-plate

behavior. Even where curvature is present, as in the cases of cylinders and spheres,

the honeycomb core cell size will normally be sufficiently small to justify such an

assumption. As noted from Reference 2-1, the critical stress for flat plates can be

expressed in the form

(2.1-1)
Crcr - 12(1-v0) _s

whe re

%r = Critical compressive stress, psi.

k = Coefficient which depends on the plate geometry, boundary


conditions, and type of loading, dimensionless.

= Plasticity reduction factor, dimensionless.

Ef = Young's modulus (for facing material in the case of intra-


cellular buckling), psi.

ve = Elastic Poisson's ratio (for facing material in the case of


intracellular buckling), dimensionless.

2-1
tf = Thicknessof plate (Facingthicknessin the caseof intra-
cellular buckling), inches.

s - A selectedcharacteristic dimensionof the plate, inches.

It is convenienthereto combineseveralof the constantsin Equation(2.1-1) to obtain

r/Ef _tf_ _ (2.1-2 )


O_r K (1- Vea ) \s/
or

%r (l-re)
= K (2.1-3)
_TEf

To apply these equations to the case of intracellular buckling, it is only necessary to

define the dimension s and establish a corresponding value for K. In Reference

2-2, Norris took s to be equal to the honeycomb core cell size. By convention,

this is taken equal to the diameter of the largest circle that can be inscribed within

the cell. Based on the analysis of test data, Norris then chose K = 2.0 for the

case of uniaxial compression. This provides a reasonably good fit to the test results

as shown in Figure 2.1-1 which was taken directly from Reference 2-2. It should be

noted that the choice of K = 2.0 does not provide a lower bound to the data. Six of

the test results fall significantly below the values predicted by the recommended

formula. This situation can be tolerated since the dimpling of several cells in a

honeycomb sandwich construction will not lead to catastrophic failure so long as a

sufficiently large number of cells remain unbuckled. As indicated by the scatter in

Figure 2.1-1, one could reasonably expect the majority of unbuckled cells to possess

considerably greater buckling strengths than would be indicated by the proposed

design curve. Under these conditions, some redistribution of stress would occur

2-2
0.1

Theoryfor Simply
_Suppor_d SquarePla_

0.01

Legend:
Dimplingin Elastic Range
• Test Datafor SpruceCorewith
SingleCircular Hole
• Test Data for Honeycomb Core
Dimpling Beyond Elastic Range
O Test Data for Spruce Core with
Single Circular Hole
[2 Test Data for Honeycomb Core
0.001

0.0005
0.01 1.0

Figure 2.1-1. Critical Stresses for Intracellular Buckling


Under Uniaxial Compression

2-3
but the structure couldcontinueto supportthe appliedload. In addition, it is pointed

out that thedimpledregionsretain significantpost-bucklingload-carryingcapability

sincetheybehaveessentiallyas flat plates. This doesnot mean,however,that one

canpermit the dimplesto growwithoutbound. The pointcanbe reachedwherethese

deformationsprecipitatewrinkling andthis cannotbe tolerated.

It is alsoof importanceto noteherethat mostof the test datashownin Figure 2.1-1

wereobtainedfrom sandwichplateshavinga solid sprucecore throughwhicha

singlecircular holewasdrilled to representa core cell. It is questionable


that

suchspecimenstruly simulatethe cell edgesupportlikely to be encounteredin

practical honeycomb
configurations. Onlythree datapointswereobtainedfor speci-

mensactuallyhavinghoneycomb
coresand, as shownin Figure 2.1-1, thesepoints

lie in the lower regionof the total bandof scatter.

In viewof theforegoingdiscussion,it is evidentthat the useof Equation2.1-3

togetherwith the selectionof K = 2.0 is certainly not a rigorous approach to the

analysis of intracellular buckling. However, until further work is accomplished in

this area, it is recommended that this criterion be employed as a 'best-available",

approximate design tool.

2-4
2.1.1.2 DesignEquationsandCurves

Thefacingstress atwhich intracellular bucklingwill occur underuniaxialcompres-

sionis givenby thefollowing semi-empiricalformula:

_cr = 2.0 _Ef


(l_Pe_) (_)_ (2.1-4)

The dimension s is the diameter of the largest circle that can be inscribed within

the cell shape. For example, in the cases of hexagonal and square cells, s is

measured as shown below.

@
Figure 2.1-2. Definition of Dimension s

Solving Equation (2.1-4) for s gives the result

(2.1-5)
s = tf ,,_ [_cr _(1- Ve_)]"j -g

This equation may be used to determine the maximum permissible cell size corre-

sponding to particular facing materials and thicknesses. Figure 2.1-3 presents a

family of plots of Equation (2.1-5) for selected values of tf ranging from tf =

0.001 to tf = 0.100.

For elastic cases, use _? = 1. Whenever the behavior is inelastic, the methods of

Section 9 must be employed.

2-5
2.00

1.00

0.80

0.60

0.40

0.30

0.04

0.03

0.02

1 2

"0Ef

Figure 2.1-'3. Chart for Determination of Core Cell Size Such That
Intracellular Buckling Will Not Occur

2-6
When the facings are subjected to biaxial compression, it is recommended that one

use the interaction formula

R x + Ry = 1 (2.1-6)

whe re

Applied Compressive Loading]


in Subscript Direction J
Ri = [Critical Compressive Loading (when] (2.1-7)
[acting alone) in Subscript DirectionJ

This straight-line interaction relationship is based on the information provided in

Reference 2-1 for square flat plates. For cases involving shearing stresses which

are coplanar with the facings, it is recommended that the principal stresses first be

computed and that these values then be used in the above interaction equation. When-

ever one of the principal stresses is tensile and the behavior is elastic, the analysis

should be based on the assumption that the compressive principal stress is acting

alone.

2-7
2.1.2 Sandwich
With CorrugatedCore

2.1.2.1 BasicPrinciples

This sectiondealswith corrugated-coresandwichconstructionswhosecross sections

maybe idealizedas shownin Figure 2.1-4. For cylinders, the only case treated

here is that where the axis of the corrugations is parallel to the axis of revolution.

For flat plates, however, the corrugations can be oriented in either the longitudinal

or transverse directions.

Single-Truss Doub le-T russ

Figure 2.1-4. Corrugation Configurations

Each of the following loading conditions is considered:

a. Uniaxial compression acting parallel to the axis of the corrugations.

b. Uniaxial compression acting parallel to the facings but normal to the


axis of the corrugations.

c. Biaxial compression resulting from combinations of a and b above.

The design curves presented here are taken directly from Reference 2-3 and are

based entirely on theoretical considerations. No comparisons are made against test

2-8
datato confirm the validity of thesesolutions. Until suchsubstantiationis obtained,

the recommended
designcurvescanonlybe consideredas a 'best-available"criterion.

It is pointedout, however,thatthere doesnot appearto be anyreasonto suspectthat

test datawoulddisagreewith the curves.

AlthoughReference2-3 is devotedsolelyto flat plates, the results are consideredto

be applicableto thecylindrical configurationsshownin Figure 2.1-4 sincethe dimen-

sions bf will usuallybe smallwith respectto the radius. Undersuchconditions,

curvatureinfluenceswill be negligible.

Thetheoreticaldevelopmentincludesconsiderationof eachof the bucklingmodes

shownin Figure 2.1-5. Both of thefollowing possibilities are covered:

a. Theface sheetsare the unstableelementsandare restrainedby the core.

b. Thecore is the unstableelementandis restrainedby theface sheets.

Bucklingis assumedto be accompanied


by rotationof the joints but with nodeflection

of the joints. Theanglesbetweenthe various elementsat anyonejoint are takento

remain unchanged
duringbuckling. It is alsoassumedthatthe over-all sandwich

dimensionsare sufficientlylarge suchthatendeffectsare negligible.

2-9
cl -oL Q ci 01

Clomped

oL o_ cl ol ol

,gl o. -el. i::i -oI


-cl ci -_ Cl -cl cl

rz _1 i1 ol cl
-_ cl -cl ol -cI,

-el - rx rl -_ _1 cl

__ply t

Single-T russ-Core Double-Truss-Core

(a, fl, and q_ denote angles of rotations at the appropriate joints)

Figure 2.1-5. Buckling Modes

2-10
2.1.2.2 DesignEquationsandCurves

Thetheoreticalstress at whichintracellular bucklingof thefacingsor bucklingof the

corrugatedcore will occuris givenby the followingformula:

kl zru 77E /tf_ _ (2.1-8)


°_cr - 12(1-V0) \bf]

where

%r = Critical compressive stress, psi.

ki = Coefficient which depends upon the geometry and loading


conditions, dimensionless.

_7 = Plasticity reduction factor, dimensionless.

E = Young's modulus of facings and core, psi.

re = Elastic Poisson's ratio of facings and core, psi.

tf = Facing thickness, inches.

bf = Pitch of corrugated core (see Figure 2.1-4), inches.

The only case considered here is that where the two facings are of the same thickness

and the entire sandwich construction (facings and core) is made of a single material.

Figures 2.1-6 through 2.1-12 give values for k i for each of the following loading

combinations:

a. kx when k_ = 0

b. kx when k_ = 0.5

c. kx when k_ = 1.0

d. ky when kx = 0

The coefficients k_ and k_ are defined as follows:

2-11
12(1-Ve _ ) (bf._ _
kx - rr _rIE _-f_ (Applied Compressive ¢rx) (2. I-9)

ky - 12(1- re2 ) (Applied Compressive O'y) (2.1-10)


_ 17E

The subscript x (for k and k') is used to identify cases where the loading is

directed along the axis of the corrugations (x direction). The subscript y (for k

and k') is used to identify cases where the loading is acting in the y direction which

is parallel to the facings but normal to the axis of the corrugations. For combinations

a through c, separate plots are furnished for single-truss-core and double-truss-

core configurations. For combination d, a single family of curves covers both

arrangements since all of the corresponding applied load is transferred through the

facings. The dashed lines in Figures 2.1-6 through 2.1-11 divide the charts into two

regions. Above the dashed lines, the face sheets are the unstable elements and are

restrained by the core. Below the dashed lines, the core is unstable and is restrained

by the face sheets.

To clarify the design charts given in Figures 2.1-6 through 2.1-12, the following

additional definitions are provided:

to = Thickness of material from which the corrugations are formed


(see Figure 2.1-4), inches.

_b = Angle shown in Figure 2.1-4, degrees.

In addition, the sample problem given below should be helpful to the user of this

handbook.

2-12
Given: SampleProblem Data for Single-TrussCore Type SandwichPanel

E = 30 x 106p si to = .016" bf = .700"

v e = .30 tf = .020" ¢ = 65 °

Proportional Limit a= 90,000 psi (ry = 16,300 psi (Compression)

Required: Find acr x ; Assuming _? = 1, one obtains

12ay(1-re2) _k_2 = 12 x 16,300 x ,910 _.70012


k_ = 7r2_E \tf / 9.87 x 1 x 30 x I0' \.020/ = 0.736

%=.o16 = .800
tf .020

Using linear interpolation between values given on Figures 2.1-7 and 2.1-8 one

obtains k x = 2.68.

Hence, the critical stress in the x direction (parallel to the corrugation axis) is

kx _2_ E /tf_ 2

aCrx - 12(1-Ve2 ) _bf/

and, assuming _ = 1, one obtains

_Crx 2,68 x 9,87 x 1 x 30 x 106f.O20h 2


= 12 x . 910 \. 700/ = 59,300 psi (Compression)

The stress intensity ai (See Section 9) can now be computed as follows:

o"i = _/O-x2 + O'y2 - ax(_y + 31"2

= 103_ f (59.3) 2 + (16.3) 2 - (59.3 x 16.3) + 0 = 53,100 psi

Since this value is below the proportional limit, the assumption _ = 1 is valid.

In cases where the qi value exceeds the proportional limit, the methods of Section

9 must be employed.

2-13
o

E_
I

_d
!

_4

2-14
0

hL
.E

2-15
r..

<.i.-.i

H
2

r,D

I.-i

.,.-I

,,,.,

2-16
0

= 2

_9

_D t_ re) _xj 0

2-17
=1

,g
11
eo

".>

.,,-i

2-18
[
ll[i

:iiiiiii
,.
I 1ii
1_]

;I

iiiitiii
:_!!!!!!!
:::::::::

iiiiiiiii
.'__!!!!!!!
!N!!iiJi
iiNiiiii
H
Mili_iii
J[l{I {1ill
'_ILI ] I IAI I I
I%J I I ]/I_l I I

ll_lllll
[ I I_I I Ii I
t I i_i_ll I [nlL[
i [l I kl l_l

t'_ll 1 IN ]l
I_ I I |k] i
U I I_1 II Ill

i 1 i ll_i 1 111
I I I • II III

! [_1 ] /!/
t i lil.l i i i i

!11]_1|1

l_Jl 1 I Illi 1

_ i i 1 IRl.Jll i I
flllll_ I ]
'WL] I ] I II{ J {

iiiiiiiii

iiiiiii;.:
,,!!144_

2-19
_:..i
.......l....
I .... H

__._-_-- --
.... -+ : ....... ZZ<01 _....

C_

I
r_

i::::b::: .... .... "X

..... + ............... _. _

i_ f_J c<J

2-20
2.2 FACE WRINKLING

2.2.1 Sandwich With Solid or Foam Core (Antisymmetric Wrinkling)

2.2.1.1 Basic Principles

The problem of face wrinkling has been treated by many investigators dating back as

far as 1940. The most important publications on this subject are listed as References

2-4 through 2-14. For the purposes of this handbook, it was decided that the results

in References 2-7 and 2-9 would be the most useful. The latter applies only to sand-

wich configurations which have solid or foam cores. The development there includes

consideration of both the symmetric and antisymmetric modes along with the influences

from initial waviness of the facings. It is pointed out that, when the core is sufficiently

thick, the wrinkle patterns of the two facings will be independent of each other and the

same critical load is obtained for the symmetric and antisymmetric modes. However,

for sandwiches having thinner cores, the core strains introduced by one facing influ-

ence the wave pattern in the other facing. Under these conditions, it was found that

sandwiches having solid or foam cores can be expected to wrinkle antisymmetrically.

The following governing equation was derived to predict this form of wrinkling for

isotropic facings subjected to uniaxial compression:

c_ _r]Ef Ec Gc_ _
{rwr : _L (1-Pea)_ (2.2-1)

whe re,

Crwr = Facing wrinkling stress, psi.

17 = Plasticity reduction factor, dimensionless.

Ef = Young's modulus of facing, psi.

2-21
E c = Young's modulus of the core in the direction normal to the facings, psi.

Gc Core shear modulus associated with the plane perpendicular to the


facings and parallel to the direction of the applied load, psi.

_e - Elastic Poisson's ratio of facings, dimensionless.

The quantity Q is the relative minimum, with respect to _ , of the expression

_
30V ÷ 16q ( cosh
sinh_- 1
5)
(2.2-2)

1 4 6.4 KS_ ( 11cosh_-


sinh _4 1 5 )

whe re

tc I (1-Ve_)13
q = _f Gc LrlEf Ec Gc] (2.2-3)

6Ec (2.2-4)
K8 - tc Fc

and

- Parameter involving the core elastic moduli, core thickness, and


buckle wavelength, dimensionless.

tc Thickness of core, inches.

tf : Thickness of facing, inches.

6 : Amplitude of initial waviness in facing, inches.

Fc : Flatwise sandwich strength (the lower of flatwise core compressive,


flatwise core tensile, and flatwise core-to-facing bond strengths),
psi.

The initial waviness plays an important role in the wrinkling phenomenon since it

causes transverse facing deflections to develop even when the applied loading is very

small. As the load increases, these deflections grow at steadily increasing rates and

lead to transverse tensile or compressive failure of the core or tensile rupture of the

2-22
core-to-facingbond. Thesefailures occur, of course, at loadvaluesbelowthe pre-

dictionsfrom classical theoryin whichit is assumedthat thefacingsare initially

perfect (K6 = 0).

The results from Reference 2-9 can be summarized in the form of Equation (2.2-1)

accompanied by plots of Q vs q with K8 as a parameter. A family of such curves

is given in Reference 2-9 and they are of the general shape shown in Figure 2.2-1.

The limiting values established by the straight line 0A correspond to the shear

crimping mode of failure (see Section 2.3). All other points on the curves al"e for

antisymmetric wrinkling. In actual practice, curves of this type do not prove to be

very helpful since the K 8 values appropriate to particular structures are rarely

known. Therefore, in order to provide a practical means for the prediction of face

wrinkling in sandwich constructions having solid or foam cores, it has become com-

mon practice to select a single conservative lower-bound Q based on available test

data. This approach is followed here. Elastic test data selected from Reference 2-9

are plotted in Figure 2.2-2 from which the value Q = 0.50 has been selected as a

safe design value. Additional data are given in Reference 2-6 which are not shown

here but lead to the same value for a lower-bound Q. This is in conformance with

the observation made by Plantema in Reference 2-15 that the value Q = 0.50 has

often been recommended for practical design purposes. However, since much of the

existing test data were obtained from specimens that were not very representative of

configurations likely to be encountered in realistic structures, the selection of Q = o. 50

can only be regarded as a "best-available" approach. In view of the uncertainties

2-23
K6 = 0

Q K 8 = Constant

K 6 = Constant

0
q
Figure 2.2-1. Typical Variation of Q vs. q

involved, it is recommended that for the verification of final designs, wrinkling tests

be performed on specimens which are truly representative of the actual configuration.

The method presented here for the prediction of wrinkling should only be regarded as

an approximate guideline.

2-24
o

.i
0
O

°,-_

0 ¢.j

Qo ¢.0 5'q
t

2-25
2.2.1.2 Design Equations and Culwes

The following equation may be used to compute the approximate uniaxial compressive

stress at which face wrinkling will occur in sandwich constructions having solid or

foam cores :

awr = Q L (1-pe 2 (2.2-5)

In cases where the amplitude of initial waviness is known, one can use the curves of

Figure 2.2-3 to establish Q. Whenever such information is unavailable, it is recom-

mended that the value Q = 0.50 be used to obtain a lower-bound prediction.

For elastic cases, use }7= 1. Whenever the behavior is inelastic, the methods of

Section 9 must be employed.

When the facings are subjected to biaxial compression, it is recommended that one use

the interaction formula

Rxa + Ry = 1 (2.2-6)
whe re

[Applied Compressive Loading in Subscript Direction]

Ri= iCritieal Compressive Loading (when acting alone) in ? (2.2-7)


Subscript Direction

and the y direction corresponds to the direction of maximum compression. This inter-

action relationship is based on the information provided in Reference 2-1 for rectangular

flat plates having very large aspect ratios. For cases involving shearing stresses which

are coplanar with the facings, it is recommended that the principal stresses first be

computed and that these values then be used in the above interaction equation. When-

ever one of the principal stresses is tensile and the behavior is elastic, the analysis

should be based on the assumption that the compressive principal stress is acting alone.

2-26
I

_o

/ 2_

//
\
d

L"-
O0

(y

2-27
2.2.2 Sandwich With Honeycomb Core (Symmetric Wrinkling)

2.2.2.1 Basic Principles

As noted in Section 2.2.1.1, the results of Reference 2-9 apply only to sandwich con-

figurations which have solid or foam cores. However, the basic theory of that report

is capable of extension to constructions having honeycomb cores and this is accomplished

in Reference 2-7. The extension is achieved by incorporating conditions which recog-

nize that the honeycomb core elastic moduli in the plane parallel to the facings are

very small in comparison with the core elastic moduli in the direction normal to the

facings. Full consideration was given to both the symmetric and antisymmetric wrin-

kling modes along with the influences from initial waviness of the facings. However,

in this case it was found that, except for the region controlled by shear crimping (low q),

symmetric wrinkling develops at stress levels which are lower than those at which the

antisymmetric mode will occur. Based on this observation, the development of Refer-

ence 2-7 resulted in the following equation for the prediction of wrinkling for isotropic

facings in sandwich constructions having honeycomb cores and subjected to uniaxial

compression:
1

082(Ec ( Ef,
awr = . \r/Ef te/
1 + 0.64 K8 (2.2-8)

where
8 Ec
K8 - tc Fc (2.2-9)

2-28
and
awr = Facingwrinkling stress, psi.

Ec = Young'smodulusof the core in thedirection normal to


the facings, psi.

tf = Thickness of facing, inches.

77 = Plasticity reduction factor, dimensionless.

Ef = YoungTs modulus of facing, psi.

tc = Thickness of core, inches.

8 = Amplitude of initial waviness in facing, inches.

Fc = Flatwise sandwich strength (the lower of flatwise core compres-


sive, flatwise core tensile, and flatwise core-to-facing bond
strengths), psi.

Equation (2.2-8) can be used to plot a family of design curves of the form shown in

Figure 2.2-4. It should be noted that the curve for K8 = 0 is an upper-bound classi-

cal value which is based on the assumption that the facings are initially perfect. This

particular curve agrees very closely with the following symmetrical wrinkling equation

recently obtained by Bartelds and Mayers [2-14] :

awr = 0.86 L_TEf tc j (r/Ef) (2.2-10)

Comparison of Equations (2.2-8) and (2.2-10) shows that, when K8 = 0, the former

gives critical stresses which are approximately 5 percent less than those obtained by

Bartelds and Mayers [2-14].

Numbers in brackets [ ] in the text denote references listed at end of each major
section (1; 2; etc.)

2-29
K(_ = 0

= Constant

K 6 = Constant

_TEf t c ]

Figure 2.2-4. Typical Design Curves for Face Wrinkling" in Sandwich


Constructions Having Honeycomb Cores

In actual practice, curves of the type shown in Figure 2.2-4 do not prove to be very

helpful since the K5 values appropriate to particular structures are rarely known.

Therefore, in order to provide a practical means for the prediction of face wrinkling

in sandwich constructions having honeycomb cores, a lower-bound approach is taken

in this handbook. For this purpose, test data selected from References 2-7 and 2-10

are plotted in Figure 2.2-5. All of the specimens from Reference 2-7 failed within the

elastic range. Several of these failures occurred by means of shear crimping and

these data were discarded. For the remaining tests reported in Reference 2-7, three

data points are plotted in Figure 2.2-5 for each group of nominally identical specimens.

One point is plotted for the maximum test value for the group, one point for the mini-

mum, and one point for the average. The data from Reference 2-10 were selected in

a similar manner with several added restrictions. A number of these specimens

wrinkled under highly inelastic conditions. Since rather crude plasticity reduction

2-30
°1°l
o
0
0 o
o
o

o _-' 0

_._

_=

e_
o

o
r/3
•C_'_

_._
o

00
o
0

2-31
factors (77 Et/Ef) wereusedin thedatareduction, it wasdecidedto plot dataonly

for thosespecimenswhichwrinkledat stress levels where (E t/Ef ) /> 0.85. In addi-

tion, many of the test specimens of Reference 2-10 had very poor eore-to-faeingbonds

as measured by flatwise tensile strengths. It was therefor(, decided to plot data only

for those specimens whose flatwise tensile strengths were at least equal to the flatwise

compressive strengths. Adhesive technology has now advanced to .the point where, with

proper care, one can usually select an adhesive system which satisfies such a require-

ment.

Based on the plot of Figure 2.2-5, the relationship

/Eetf _

O'w r = 0.33\r/E f te / (_TSf) (2.2-11)

has been selected here to provide safe design values. This implies that a knock-down

factor of approximately 0.4 is applicable to this wrinkling phenomenon. Obviously,

this is not a rigorous approach to the problem and it would be advisable to base the

design equation on a much wider selection of test data of specimens which were truly

representative of contemporary practical designs. Therefore, Equation (2.2-11) can

only be regarded as a '_est-aw_ilable" approach and it is recommended that, for veri-

fication of final designs, wrinkling tests be performed on specimens that actually dup-

licate the selected sandwich configuration. The method presented here should only be

regarded as an approximate guideline.

2-32
2.2.2.2 Design Equations and Curves

The following equation may be used to compute the approximate uniaxial compressive

stress at which face wrinkling will occur in sandwich constructions having honeycomb

cores:

z/Ec
0.8 tc/ (,El)
°'wr- 1 + 0.64 K(5 (2.2-12)

whe re

(]Ec
K6 - tc Fc (2.2-13)

In cases where the amplitude of initial waviness is known, one can either use these

equations or the curves given in Figures 2.2-6 and 2.2-7 to establish the wrinkling

stress. Both of these figures are taken directly from MIL-HDBK-23 [2-16]. When-

ever the initial waviness is unknown, it is recommended that the following equation be

used to obtain a lower-bound prediction:

awr = 0.33 \_--_f tc/ (UEf) (2.2-14)

For elastic cases, use 77 = 1. Whenever the behavior is inelastic, the methods of

Section 9 must be employed.

When the facings are subjected to biaxial compression, it is recommended that one use

the interaction formula


3
R x + Ry = 1 (2.2-15)

where

[Applied Compressive Loading in Subscript Direction]


Ri= (2.2-16)
Critical Compressive Loading (when acting alone) in]
Subscript Direction

2-33
CD 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 O0

i
4hl/,/l
ll " _o
CD

/ LO

//
/ _I
_

, /// CO
0 o

z.//, /
0

I>

0
C_

jjz//
f

&

2-34
0

?]

II 11
¢£:

.....

oi 0

b b _J
and the y direction corresponds to the direction of maximum compression. This

interaction relationship is based on the information provided in Reference 2-1 for

rectangular flat plates having very large aspect ratios. For cases involving shearing

stresses which are coplanar with the facings, it is recommended that the principal

stresses first be computed and that these values then be used in the above interaction

equation. Whenever one of the principal stresses is tensile and the behavior is elastic,

the analysis should be based on the assumption that the compressive principal stress

is acting alone.

2-36
2.3 SHEARCRIMPING

2.3.1 BasicPrinciples

To understandthe phenomenon
of shearcrimping, onemustkeepin mindthatthis

modeof failure is simplya limiting caseof generalinstability. Theequationsfor

predictingshearcrimpingemergefrom generalinstability theorywhenthe analytical

treatmentextendsinto the regionof lowshearmodulifor the core. For example,the

theoreticalderivationof Reference2-17, as reformulatedin Section4.2. I. 1 of this

handbook,yields the result that, whenthetwo facingsare of the samematerial, shear

crimpingwill occurin axially compressedsandwichcylinderswhenever

Vc _ 2 (2.3-1)
where
_o
V c = (2.3-2)
Crerimp

h 2 xJtz t2
(2.3-3)
(ro = *)Ef_ l___pe2(tl + re)

h_
(2.3-4)
°'crimp - (tl + t2) tc Gxz

= Plasticity reduction factor, dimensionless.

Ef = Young's modulus of facings, psi.

h = Distance between middle surfaces of facings, inches.

R = Radius to middle surface of cylindrical sandwich, inches.

t_ and t_ = Thicknesses of the facings (There is no preference as to which


facing is denoted by the subscript 1 or 2.), inches.

Pe = Elastic Poisson's ratio of facings, dimensionless.

2-37
t C 'l'hickn_,ss of core, inches.

Gxz ,_. _r-< shear modulus associate,I with the plane perpendicular to the
facings and crienled in the axial direction, psi.

The critical stress c:m t)(_ dt, termined from the eq_mtion

% r' Kc % (2.3-5)

and, when the Inequality (2. :{-1) holds true, Kc: can be computed as follows:

1
(2.3-6)

Hence,

'{; rimp
"i?, ....... _'_-7- _r° : 'rcri'nP (2.3-7)

Therefore, when the two facings ",re made of the same material, the following equation

can be written for the c_'itk_'t! stres_ for _h¢,ar crimpir_g in a circular sandwich cylinder

under axial compression:

h _

_r_r : (r . _ixz (2.3-8)


crimp 7t: ! t>_) t c

I ' 4 .) • .
An equlvalen_ rest)It can be obtained from Referen¢'e :_-t _ for sandwich cylinders sub-

je,"led [(_ _mif,__,'m e>:t,",_i !g_!,,ra! pressure. Tim! ,_, ,.:i_,,c_, the two facings are made

of t}l(_ .'a{!til(' Illa[eFi:'J, _}l i, ( ;_n ',vl'Jte

rrcr :: (r crimp
. - (t t + re)t e O.vz (2 3-9)

x\' h e 9"e

Gyz ;'-,_',, sl_( :z_' ul _d_!t s us,;¢)( iated with the tqane perpendicular to the
'l'<i';
',rrcvol,!lion, psi.
In addition, the development of Reference 2-19 leads one to the following formula for

circular sandwich cylinders under pure torsion and having both facings made of the

same material :

- h2 JGxz (2.3-10)
-rcr = "rcrim p (t 1 + t2) tc GY z

It should be noted that, although Equations (2.3-8) through (2.3-10) were derived for

sandwich cylinders, all of these final expressions are independent of curvature. Thus,

these equations have a general applicability which is not limited to the cylindrical con-

figuration.

2-39
2.3.2 Design Equations

The following equations may be used to compute the facing stresses at which shear

crimping will occur in sandwich constructions having both facings made of the same

mate rial:

ao For uniaxial compression acting coplanar with the facings (see Figure 2.3-1),

use

h _

_crimp = (t_ + t_) tc Gij (2.3-11)

where

Gij = Core shear modulus associated with the plane perpendicular to


the facings and parallel to the direction of loading, psi.

O', psi

o-, ps .i___

o-, psi _

Figure 2.3-1. Unia×ial Compression

2-40
bo For pure shear acting coplanar with the facings (see Figure 2.3-2), use

h_ (2 3-12)
Tcrimp - (t_+ t2) tc _GxzGyz

Figure 2.3-2. Pure Shear

The foregoing equations are valid regardless of the overall dimensions of the structure.

m addition, no knock-down factors are required since shear crimping is insensitive to

initialimperfections. The predictions from these equations will be somewhat conserva-

tive since their derivations neglect bending of the facings about their own middle sur-

faces. Although such bending is of negligible importance to most sandwich buckling

phenomena, in the case of shear crimping thls influence can be considerable.

Further mention of the shear crimping mode of failure is made in the various sections

on general instability included in this handbook.

2-41
_4

= i-

ECJ

o
2_
• ,_ _
©
O

<

_ g _
_D • b_
m _

.Z

b£.

o
c-i ,"

._ °
b _ r,9 ¢-/ _ m ._ b ._ c'd
o_ o e r2_
la., el _-) L:I

Z ;

i i#_ _

i_ iII ¢',1

.-A

i i

©
i,-ii
)-'( I _,,._

e_
_'i

,--i

2 -42
= 4o

7
¢o

o _

°_, °} S_

_'_ _ • I

_ m
a _

"0 0

_ ._ ._f
•.,_,_-_
o _, ._

i ._ _ .

i ,°
_ .

:i 0
"_ b _ _ _ ._ _ be
%
0

8
g g g

1ii
c,|

2-43
RE FERENC ES

2-1 Gerard, George and Becker, Herbert, "Handbook of Structural Stability,

Part I - Buckling of Flat Plates," NACA Technical Note 3781, July 1957.

2-2 Norris, C. B., "Short-Column Compressive Strength of Sandwich Construc-

tions as Affected by Size of Cells of Honeycomb Core Materials," U. S.

Forest Service Research Note, FPL-026, January 1964.

2-3 Anderson, M. S., "Local Instability of the Elements of a Truss-Core

Sandwich Plate," NASA Technical Report R-30, 1959.

2-4 Gough, C. S., Elam, C. F., and deBruyne, N. A., "The Stabilization of a

Thin Sheet By a Continuous Supporting Medium," Journal of the Royal Aero-

nautical Society, January 1940.

2-5 Williams, D., Leggett, D.M.A., and Hopkins, H. G., "Flat Sandwich Panels

Under Compressive End Loads," Royal Aircraft Establishment Report No.

A.D. 3174, June 1941.

2-6 Hoff, N. J. and Mautner, S. E., '_rhe Buckling of Sandwich Type Panels,"

Journal of the Aeronautical Sciences, Vol. 12, No. 3, July 1945.

2-7 Norris, C. B., Boller, K. H., and Voss, A. W., 'WVrinkling of the Facings

of Sandwich Construction Subjected to Edgewise Compression," FPL Report

No. 1810-A, June 1953.

2-8 Yusuff, S., "Theory of Wrinkling in Sandwich Construction," Journal of the

Royal Aeronautical Society, Vol. 59, January 1955.

2-9 Norris, C, B., Ericksen, W. S., March, H. W., Smith, C. B., and Boller,

K. H., "Wz2nkling of the Facings of Sandwich Constructions Subjected to

Edgewise Compression," FPL Report No. 1810, March 1956.

2-45
2-10 Jenklnson, P. M. and Kuenzi, E. W,, "Wrinkling of the Facings of Aluminum

and Stainless Steel Sandwich Subjected to Edgewise Compression, " FPL

Report No. 2171, December 1959.

2-11 Yusuff, S., "Face Wrinkling and Core Strength in Sandwich Construction,"

Journal of the Royal Aeronautical Society, Vol. 64, March 1960.

2-12 Harris, B. J. and Crisman, W. C., "Face-Wrinkling Mode of Buckling of

Sandwich Panels," Proceedings of the American Society of Civil Engineers,

Journal of the Engineering Mechanics Division, June 1965.

2-13 Benson, A. S. m_d Mayers, J., "General Instability and Face Wrinkling of

Sandwich Plates - Unified Theory and Applications," AIAA Paper No. 66-138

Presented in New York, New York, January 1966.

2-14 Bartelds, G. and Mayers, J., "Unified Theory for the Bending and Buckling of

Sandwich Shells - Application to Axially Compressed Circular Cylindrical

Shells," Department of Aeronautics and Astronautics, Stanford University

Report No. SUDAAR No. 287, November 1966.

2-15 Plantema, F. J., Sandwich Construction, John Wiley & Sons, Inc., New York,

Copyright 1966.

2-16
U. S. Department of Defense, Structural Sandwich Composites, MIL-HDBK-23,

30 December 1968.

2-17
Zatm, J. J. and Kuenzi, E. W., "Classical Buckling of Cylinders of Sandwich

Construction in Axial Compression - Orthotropic Cores," U. S. Forest Service

Research Note FPL-018, November 1963.

2-18
Kuenzi, E. W., Bohannan, B., and Stevens, G. H., "Buckling Coefficients for

Sandwich Cylinders of Finite Length Under Uniform External Lateral Pressure,

U. S. Forest Service Research Note FPL-0104, September 1965.

2-46
2-19 March, H. W. and Kuenzi, E. W., "Buckling of Sandwich Cylinders in

Torsion," FPL Report No. 1840, January 1958.

2-47
3
GENERAL INSTABILITY OF FLAT PANELS

3.1 RECTANGULAR PLATES

3. i. 1 General

As previously noted, one of the potential modes of failure for sandwich panels is that

of general instability. This occurs when the panel becomes elastically unstable under

the application of certain types of in-plane loads. Further, it should be noted, the

loads which are critical for instability may or may not be of such magnitude as to

cause a failure of the basic materials.

The fiat, rectangular sandwich panel represents that configuration for which the vast

majority of fabrication and test data has been accumulated over the past decade. This

is probably due to the fact that this configuration was best adapted to the structural

needs for a number of applications and that it represented the minimum in fabrication

problems and costs as far as this type of construction is concerned. By the same

token, analytical solutions have been developed for a wide range of loading applications

for flat panels, and an appreciable amount of testing for correlation with these solu-

tions has been accomplished.

As a consequence of this past work, it is now possible to employ the analytical solu-

tions for fiat panels, as given in MIL-HDBK-23, [3-1], with a high degree of con-

fidence. This view is supported by recommendations given in References 3-2 through

3-7, inclusive, for basic panel design. Therefore, with this background in mind, the

3-1
buckling coefficients, K, which will be given in this section for the various plate loading

conditions will be those taken from the applicable sections of Reference 3-1, with no

"knock down" factor to be applied to them.

The development of plate buckling coefficients for sandwich construction requires the

consideration of a ntmlber of factors, some are: 1) the degree of orthotropicitsr of the

face plates, 2) the use of the same or of dissimilar materials for the face plates and,

3) the degree of orthotropicity of the core material. The general equations given in

the following sections account for these possibilities; however, the curves showing K

as a function of (a/b), V, the type of loading and edge support conditions will assume

the use of isotropic faceplate materials since this is largely typical of aerospace

vehicle design practices.

In all cases, the final design of the sandwich panel must comply with the following four

basic design principles, Reference 3-1;

a. The sandwich facings shall be at least thick enough to withstand the chosen
design stresses under the application of the ultimate design loads.

b. The core shall be thick enough and have sufficient shear rigidity and
strength so that over-all sandwich buckling, excessive deflection, and
shear failure will not occur under the design loads.

c. The core shall have high enough moduli of elasticity, and the sandwich
shall have great enough flatwise tensile and compressive strength such
that wrinkling of either facing will not occur under the design loads.

d. If the core is a cellular honeycomb or constructed of corrugated material


and dimpling of the facings is not permissible, the cell size or corrugation
spacing shall be small enough so that dimpling of either facing into the
core spaces will not occur under the design loads.

3-2
Otherrequirementsincludethe useof moduli of elasticity andstressvaluesrepre-

sentativeof thosevalueswhichprevail underthe conditionsof use. Also, wherethe

stressesare beyondtheproportionallimit, the appropriatereducedmodulusof elas-

ticity shouldbeused.

The followingsectionson specifictypesof panelloadsdefinethe appropriateequations

for eachparticular situationanddiscussusefullimits andother considerations,as

applicable. A summarytable, (Table3-1), listing the panelinstability equationsgiven

in the variousparts of this section, alongwith a definitionof terms, equationlimitations

if any, andreferencesfor the appropriatebucklingcurvesimmediatelyprecedesthe list

of referencesto facilitate useof the manualfor specificproblemsolution.

Figure3.1-1 showselasticproperties anddimensionsfor the typical sandwichpanel


underconsiderationin this section.

3-3
_,_ b[ __ _tf
--_ b__..t _

ttf W-bf --q \¢ •/ t¢ _-_-'t


(TYPICAL) f

SINGLE -TRuss DOUBLE -TRUSS

CORRUGATED CORE CONFIGURATIONS

_h-_

N
v

CORE --,

E b, Gcb

4-t4 _--t
tl-_ C 2
.-t-o

ItONEYCOMB CORE

-e_ b

---.--]_ y

Figure 3.1-1. Elastic Properties and Dimensional Notations


for a Typical Sandwich Panel

3-4
3.1.2 Uniaxial Edgewise Compression

3.1.2.1 Basic Principles

The buckling coefficient equations and curves given here for uniaxial edgewise com-

pression arc those originally developed by Ericksen and March, _3-8], and are in-

cluded in the MIL-HDBK-23 documents, issued since then. The basic principles and

assumptions employed in the development of these general instability equations are

noted in the references and are not repeated here except where required to limit their

use because of the original restrictions imposed.

The basic equations for calculation of the allowable sandwich panel edgewise com-

pression loads are given in the following section. Curves for panel buckling coeffi-

cients for panels having isotropic facepk-ttes and both orthotropic and isotropic cores

for various panel edge support conditions follow the equations.

3.1.2.2 Design Equations and Curves

As previously noted, the equations presented in this section arc those developed by

Ericksen and March, and presented in MIL-HDBK-23, as well as in other documents.

Supporting data such as pertinent assumptions and definition of terms are also in-

cluded along with the equations.

Sandwich Panels With Honeycomb Cores

One of the basic assumptions used in the design and analysis of sandwich panels is

that the face plates carry the inplane loads applied and that the core provides that

shear support to the face plates required for them to act as a unit in preventing early

3-5
individual buckling. From this, the edgewise compression capability of the panel is

given by the following equations, which are taken from Section 5.3, Reference 3-1:

N = (_2/b_)(K)(D) (3.1-1)
cr

where D is the sandwich bending stiffness. Solving this equation for the facing sires-

ses gives the following:

(E_t_)(E_t_) (h_) (_ (3.1-2)


l'c_, = = _7_K (E_t_ _ E't2)2 (b _) k

For equal facings:

E I
_K (h)_ f
F - (3.1-3)
e 4 (b) 2 )_

w he re

K = buckling coefficient = K + K (see definitions in following


F M
work).

1
E J
= (,'a = effective modulus ()f elasticity for orthotropic

facings.

X = (1 - _ta_b)

_a'_b = Poisson's ratio as measured parallel to the subscript direction.

f, 1, 2 = subscripts denoting facings.

h,b = see Figure 3.1-1.

Since the buckling coefficient curves to be presented here are being limited to the case

of isotropic face plates, which is representative of the large majority of structural

sanchvich applications, the affected equations given previously arc revised below for

this situation.

3-6
For isotropic facings:

Eai' = E' bi = E.'1 = 77iEi; and _ai = _bi = _i

where 77i = plasticity correction factor (see Section 9.0).

As noted above the buckling coefficient for the panel under this loading condition is

given by the equation

K = KF+K M

where

KF - 12 E_t a (E/t2) h_ KM (3.1-4)


0

KM = KM for the case where V=0 Esee Figure (3.1-16)1 (3.1-5)


O

Values of K F are generally quite small relative to KM, thus a safe first approximation

is to assume it is equal to zero until a final panel check is made. On this basis, K

= K M may be used to develop initial face plate and core thicknesses for the panel.

K M is a theoretical coefficient which is dependent on the sandwich panel bending and

shear rigidities and panel aspect ratio. Other factors which influence the magnitude

of this coefficient include the panel edge support conditions and the orthotropicity of

the core. A discussion of these considerations along with development of the equations

for calculation of this coefficient are given in References 3-1 and 3-8. This manual

does not propose to repeat these equations here; however, the curves shown in Figures

3.1-2 through 3.1-15 give values of K M as a function of edge support condition, panel

aspect ratio, and the bending-shear rigidity parameter, V which is defined as follows

y_D
V - b2U (3.1-6)

3-7
which further canbewritten as:
-It
C
V = (3.1-7)
kb; Ge (E_t,+E;t:)

_2 t t
c Eftf
V - (for equal facings) (:3.1-7a)
2). b 2 G
C

where U is sandwich shear stiffness; Gc is the core shear modulus associated with the

axes parallel to direction of loading (also parallel to panel side of length a) and per-

pendicular to the plane of the panel.

An indication of the influence and importance of the core shear modulus may be obtained

from inspection of the above equations for V m_d the curves giving values of K M given

later. Holding all terms constant except G , an increase in its value reduces the value
e

of V to be used with the buckling coefficient curves, this reduced value then calls for

an increased value of K
M"

Sandwich Panels With Corrugated Core

The equations and fornmlas previously given are for sandwich panels with honeycomb

cores; however, they may be adapted to cover the case of panels with corrugated cores

by means of the following modifications:

a. For the case where the corrugation flutes are oriented normal to the direc-
tion of the load application, the shear modulus in the direction parallel to
the flutes, Geb, is very high with respect to the shear modulus parallel to

the direction 2f andl°ading'R Ge :}; thus,= 0.the previous curves may be used by
letting Gcb = = Gca/Gcb

b. For the case where the corrugation flutes are parallel to the direction of
loading, the corrugations may be assumed to carry load in a direct pro-
poYtion to their area and elastic modulus. The parameter V for this case
is replaced by the parameter W, which is defined as

3-8
e
= i (3.1-8)
W ).b2Gcb (E_t_ + E_t,)

Or, for equal facings,

W = _t cE'[t/2xb 2 Gab (3.1-8a)

Values of K M as a function of (b/a), R = (Gea/Gcb), and V, or W, are given for various

edge support conditions in Figures 3.1-2 through 3.1-15, with Figures 3.1-14 and

3.1-15 representing the case of panels having corrugated cores.

Figure 3.1-16 gives values of KMo as a function of panel aspect ratio and edge support

conditions for use in determining values of K F in order that final values for K may be

obtained for specific designs.

The curves and equations just given may be used in developing a panel design in addi-

tion to checking the adequacy of an existing design; however, this is a slow iterative

process. As a consequence, this manual recommends the use of the design-procedures

approach described in Reference 3-1 since it was specifically developed to expedite the

new design process.

3-9
]

10
2.5 Gc
END

V
05

0.15
0.30

1
FOR V>0.40 tC =--
M V
o .__ _k .... 1 1
0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0

a b
b a

Figure 3.1-2. K M for a Sandwich Panel with Ends and Sides Simply Supported,
Isotropic Facings, and Orthotropic Core, (R = 0.40)

3-10
14

12

10

.20
2 .40
0.60
1 -- 1.00
FORV > 1.00 _.'=
M
0 i i .
0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0

a b
b a

Figure 3. i-3. K M for Sandwich Panel with Ends and Sides Simply Supported,
Isotropic Facings, and Isotropic Core, (R = 1.00)

3-11
14
.... .......... [ l-i

I I

12 I 2
II

1_ _ !
10 V - rr D
b2U
0.4G i
8 ° I
END 'r

I_ _1
I- b -I
KM X I

0.10
0.20
0.30
1
FOR V >2.50 I( = 1 O.5O
M V
o t i I 2.50
0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0

a b
b
a

Figure 3.1-4. K M for Sandwich Panel with Ends and Sides Simply Supported,
Isotropic Facings, and Orthotropic Core, (R = 2.50)

3-12
16

14
2
?r D
12 V m

b2 U

10

_0.05

.10
.15
0.20
0.25
0.30

0
0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0

b
a
a
b

Figure 3.1-5. K M for Sandwich Panel with Ends Simply Supported and Sides
Clamped, Isotropic Facings, and Orthotropic Core, (R=0.40)

3-13
16 T I

14"I ....

12

10
1 V m
2
?r D

b2 U
G

END
c
_,

S
\ v
0

0.I0

0.20
0.30
0.40
0.60
1 0.75

0 FOR V a>0.75 KM=__ V


0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2

.-_ b
a

Figure 3.1-6. K M for Sandwich Panel with Ends Simply Supported and Sides
Clamped, Isotropic Facings, and Isotropic Core, (R=I.00)

3-14
16 i T

i i
14 I l
L_o
2
D
12 V m

b2U 0.4G
C
END
10 L_ -- -- -
] I

V
8
0

6
\
\
0.10

0.20
0.30
0.60
1 1.00
.l, =_77:1-- 1. 875
FOR V > i1.875 lK_"
0 J

0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0

b
a
a
b

Figure 3.1-7. K M for Sandwich Panel with Ends Simply Supported and Sides
Clamped, Isotropic Facings, and Orthotropic Core, (R= 2.50)

3-15
16

14

12

.30
O. 40
1
FOR V >0.40 K - V
0
o 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0

a b
b a

Figure 3.1-8. K M for Sandwich Panel with Ends Clamped and Sides Simply
Supported, Isotropic Facings, and Orthotropic Core, (R=0.40)

3-16
16

14
2
D
12 V
b2U
G
C

END

1
0 FORVi > i.?0 K M=_ V
0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2

a b
b a

Figure 3.1-9. K M for Sandwich Panel with Ends Clamped and Sides Simply
Supported, Isotropic Facings, and Isotropic Core, (R = 1.00)

3-17
16--
I
14 ...... l,

\ 2
D

\
12
b2 U

0.4G
C

\ END

K
M
6
t

0
0 0.2 0.4

Figure 3.1-10. K M for Sandwich Panel with Ends Clamped and Sides Simply
Supported, Isotropic Facings, and Orthotropic Core, (R= 2.50)

3-18
;_iA
14
2 0°
V = __
rr D 1'
12 \ b2U

\, 2.5G
END
e

2 ?
1
FoR v > 0.30 % - V
o 1
0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0
a b
b a

Figure 3.1-11. K M for Sandwich Panel with Ends and Sides Clamped, Isotropic
Facings, and Orthotroptc Core, (R = 0.40)

3-19
16
.... _.....] 1 i i
14

b2U
12

END
I _'_
10

0.i0

O. 20
0.30
0.40
0.50
I 1 0.75
FOR V >0.75 K =--
M \7
0 / i •

0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 0.8 0 6 0.4 0.2 0

a b
b a

Figure 3.1-12. K M for Sandwich Panel with Ends and Sides Clamped, Isotropic
Facings, and Isotropic Core, (R = 1.00)

3-20
16

14 2
D
V =
b2 U
12
0.4G
e
END _'

V
8
0

O. 10

0.20
0.30
0.60
1 1.00
FORV > 1.875 K.o -- --_ 1.875
0 1 J M v
0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0

a b
b a

Figure 3.1-13. KM for Sandwich Panel with Ends and Sides Clamped, Isotropic
Facings, and Orthotropic Core, (R = 2.50}

3-21
14
I
V =0

12

lp

10

=0.1
2
Tr Dt
c
+I t
V _t: Gb=_
b2h2 G
ca _L
I t? _,
\
°v0 \
[ l

V_0.4

0
0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0
a b
b a

Figure 3.1-14. K M for Simply Supported Sandwich Panel Having a Corrugated


Core. Core Corrugation Flutes are Perpendicular to the
Load Direction

3-22
14

12

2 Dt
C

]0 W

b 2 h 2 Gob

0.1

_'--0o2
_- o.4

0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0


a b
b a

Figure 3.1-15. K M for Simply Supported Sandwich Panel Having a Corrugated


Core. Core Corrugation Flutes are Parallel to the Load
Direction

3-23
END t

\
\
K
Mo \

0.i 0.2
a

Figure 3.1-16. KMo for Sandwich Panel with Isotropie Facings


in Edgewise Compression

3-24
3.1.3 Edgewise Shear

3.1.3.1 Basic Principles

As noted earlier in Section 3.1.1, sufficient analysis, design, and testing of flat sand-

wich panels has been accom,lished to demonstrate the adequacy of the analytical

approaches presently in use. Thus, the panel buckling coefficient equations and

curves given in the following paragraphs for edgewise shear are those taken from the

MIL-ttDBK-23 documents presently in use. These equations were originally developed

by Kuenzi and Ericksen E3-13] and employ the same general assumptions as those

described in Section 3.1.1. Specific limitations or restrictions on the use of these

equations will be noted where these require consideration.

The basic equations for use in calculation of the allowable sandwich panel edgewise

shear loads are given in the following section along with applicable background data

and assumptions. Design curves and buckling coefficients for panels having isotropic

faceplates and both orthotropic and isotropic cores for both simply supported and

clamped edge conditions follow the equations.

3.1.3.2 Design Equations and Curves

The design equations presented here are taken from Reference 3-1 and 3-13. Support-

ing data and design constraints are also noted and discussed as required.

The edgewise shear load carrying capability of a sandwich panel is given by the follow-

ing equation:

Nser = (Tr_/b_) (Ks) (D) (3.1-9)

3-25
where
Nscr = critical edgewise shear load, lb per inch

D = sandwich bending stiffness

Solving this for the facing st_'esses gives the following equation:

/ I f
(E_tI)(E_t_)(he)E z,
Fsz,_ = _K , + i (3.1-10)
s (Elt 1 E_t_) (be) x

Or, for equal facings

y2K s (h e) Ef'
F - (3.1-10a)
s 4 (b_)k

where

E' is the effective modulus of elasticity of facing at stress F s = 7/E

r_ = plasticity correction factor (Section 9.0)

X = 1-D 2

= _ = p_ = Poisson's ratio of facings

h = distance between facing centroids (Figure 3.1-1)

b = panel width (<a) (Figure 3.1-1)

Ks = KF + KM (Note: These terms differ from those of Section 3.1.2)

whe re

i 3 t
(E_t_3 + E_t2 ) (E'_t_+ E_t_)KMo

KF = 12(E_t_)(E,2t_
) h2 (3.1-11)

Or, for equal facings

(tf_KMo
KF = 3h 2 (3.l-lla)

KMo = value ofK M for V=W=0

3-26
The equation defining the value of K M is quite complex and involved, being dependent

on panel aspect ratio, (a/b), the number of half-waves, (n), for the minimum energy

buckle pattern, and the panel bending and shear rigidityparameter, (V, or W). This

manual proposes to follow general practice in the literature and provide curves only

for the definition of this buckling coefficient. Those interested in the basic equation

and its development will find this in Reference 3-13.

Values of K M are given in Figures 3.1-17 through 3.1-24 as a function of the panel

aspect ratio and the parameter V, or W, for various panel edge support conditions.

These figures cover panels with isotropic faceplates and both isotropic and orthotropie

core, including panels using corrugated flutes for cores. Values of the buckling coeffi-

cient, KMo, may also be obtained from the same set of figures.

The equations defining the parameters V and W are the same as those given in the

previous section for edgewise compression; however, they are repeated below to

facilitate their use. The equation numbers previously assigned to them are retained

below

(Y% tc
(E_tl)(E'_t2) (3.1-7)
V = k(E[t_ +E_t 2) (b 2) G
ca

(3.1-7a)
V = _r_tcE'ft/2),b2 Gca (equal facings)

For a sandwich panel with a corrugated core in which the corrugation flutes are parallel

to the edge of length a, the parameter V is replaced by the parameter W which is de-

fined as follows:

3-27
W

)_b2 %b {EIlt_ + E_ta) (3.1-8)

Or, for equal facings

W = rr_t c E_t/2kb e Gcb (3.1-8a)

In checking a particular design for the critical buckling stress, Fscr, Figures 3.1-17

through 3.1-21 should be used for those panels having all edges simply supported.

Curves of K M for sandwich panels having all edges clamped are given in Figures

3.1-22 through 3.1-24. These curves may be interpolated in order to obtain the

buckling coefficients for other values of core orthotropicity, (R = Gea/Gcb), and inter-

mediate values of V or W°

It should be noted that if the resulting value of F is above the proportional limit
set

value, the value of E' shall be an effective value based on that stress level, and this

effective value shall be used in computing the value of V, Equation (3.1-7) or (3.1-7a)

or W, Equation (3.1-8) or (3.1-8a), as the case may be. This same effective value

for E I shall also be used in Equation (3.1-10), or (3.1-10a) when calculating the criti-

cal panel buckling stress. Thus, several interations will be required to establish the

actual value of F scr in those cases where it exceeds the proportional limit.

The equations and curves just given may be used in the development of panel designs

as well as in checking an existing design; however, as was the case for uniaxial com-

pression, this is a lengthy iterative process. Thus, this manual recommends the use

of the design-procedures approach described in Reference 3-1 for those cases where

the initiation of new designs is required.

3-28
10
0
l
2
7r 1) /
b2U /

0.05

0.10

KM

---- 0.40

[ 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0


0
b
a

K M for a Sandwich Panel with All Edges Simply Supported,


Figure 3.1-17.
and an Isotropie Core, (R = 1.00)

3-29
10
V

0.4 G

0.40

b
a

Figure 3.1-18.
K M for a Sandwich Panel with All Edges Simply Supported,
and an Orthotropic Core, (R = 2.50)

3-30
J

ff

10

t_
2
D
/
t_L
b2 U /
/
/

0.05

_J" J

O. 20

0.40

C
0 0.2 0.4 b 0.6 0.8 1.0

Figure 3.1-19. K M for a Sandwich Panel with All Edges Simply Supported,
and with an Orthotropic Core, (R = 0.40)

3-31
10

K
M 5
i

0
0 0.4
b
a

Figure3.1-20.
K M for a Sandwich Panel with All Edges Simply Supported,
Isotropic Facings and Corrugated Core. Core
Corrugation Flutes are Parallel to Side a

3-32
10
V

9- -r 2
_r t D

I '
c

_L V

b2 h2 G
ca -
/ 0.05
_b_ / " /
/ /
7 1
i /
1
f
// 0.20

J J
_J
i
i
i
I
KM O. 50
11
I
jl
4

0
0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0
b
a

Figure 3.1-2 i. K M for a Sandwich Panel with All Edges Simply Supported,
Isotropic Facings and Corrugated Core. Core
Corrugation Flutes are Parallel to Side b

3-33
16
V

14

l Gc

12

10

0.05

K M
O. i0

O. 20

0
0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0
b

Figure 3.1-22. K M for a Sandwich Panel with All Edges Clamped,


Isotropic Facings and Isotropic Core, (R = 1.00)

3-34
16

2 0

14 i
I
V
77 D
----"--

b2 U
/
0.4G
c
If /
/
12 _-b ---4

10 | i r_

I jj
J

0.05
5_ 7
J
J
_..I
6 v
I
_J

J 0.10
I
I

0.20

o I
0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0
b
a

Figure 3.1-23. K M for a Sandwich Panel with All Edges Clamped,


Isotropic Facings and Orthotropic Core, (R=2.50)

3-35
16
V

14
2
_r D
/
0

Il 2.s C
II
"_----- _

12

10 0.05

0.i0
K
M

.2O

0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0


b
a

Figure 3.1-24. K M for a Sandwich Panel with All Edges Clamped,


Isotropic Facings and Orthotropic Core, (R= 0.40)

3-36
3.1.4 Edgewise Bending Moment

3.1.4.1 Basic Principles

The application of an edgewise bending moment to a flat, rectangular sandwich panel

produces a loading condition such as that shown in Figure 3.1-25. This represents a

somewhat different situation from the ones previously covered, since the tension loading

on one half of the panel represents a stabilizing effect. The edge compression load

on the other half of the panel varies linearly from zero at the neutral axis to a maxi-

mum value, N, at the panel edge. It is this compression loading which can produce

panel buckling in the same fashion as the uniaxial compression case; however, the

presence of the panel edge support along the line of maximum loading forces consider-

ation of a more complex failure mode.

These failure mode considerations for this type of loading have been covered in the

development of analytical techniques for the evaluation of flat plates (Reference 3-17).

hlso, as has been previously noted, sufficient analytical development and testing has

been accomplished on flat, rectangular sandwich panels to enable the use of the buckling

coefficients given in Reference 3-1 for this loading condition with complete confidence.

The general equations for the behavior of flat, rectangular honeycomb sandwich panels

under this loading condition were developed by Kimel E3-15] while whose applicable to

panels with a corrugated core were developed by Harris and Auelman, E3-14] and E3-16].

The assumptions employed in the development of the basic equation for the panel sta-

bility coefficient for this loading condition are generally the same as those described

3-37
in Section 3.1.1, with one particulal' exception. This exception requires that the

critical design faeeplate stress, Fcr, shall not exct,ed the elastic buckling stress for

the faceplates. This requirement stresses the fact that the analysis is based on a

linear loading variation across the edge of the panel. Once the elastic buckling stress

is exeeede.d this variation is no longer linear, and extrapolation to a buckling stress

beyond the elastic range of facing stresses cannot be done by using an effective elastic

modulus such as the tangent modulus, in the buckling formulas. Since the proper

extrapolation to stresses beyond the elastic range must consider the variation of

effective elastic modulus across the panel width associated with the stress variation,

the equations and buckling coefficier_ts given here are thus strictly applicable only to

buckling at facing stresses within the elastic range.

The basic equations to be used in the calculation of the allowable sandwich panel edge

loading are given in the following section. Design curves and buckling coefficients

for panels having isotropic faceplates and both isolropic and orthotropic cores based

on simply supported edge conditions follow these equations.

3.1.4.2 Design Equations and Curves

The design equations presented here arc those taken from Reference 3-1. Background

assumptions and any applicable design constraints are also covered.

Using a linear stress variation as previously discussed, the value of N at the panel

edge is given by the equation:

N = 6M/b _ (3.1-12)

3-38
where
N _-_
load per unit width of edge

M = edgewise bending moment

b = panel width (Figure 3.1-25)

The edgewise bending load capability of a sandwich panel is given by the following

equation, taken from Reference 3-1:

N (3.1-13)
er = (_,/be) (%) (D)

where

N = critical edgewise loading, lb per inch


er

D = sandwiehbending stiffness

The critical faceplate stresses are obtained by solution of the previous equation and

are as follows:

(E1t_)(E2t_) (h_) (El,s)


Fe_,_ = Y2Kb (Eli
a +E_t_) 2 (be) 1 (3.1-14)

Or, for equal facings,

F = (3.1-14a)
c 4 (b _) ),

whe re

E = modulus of elasticity of facing

I = (1 - _)

= Poisson's ratio of facings: /_a = _b assumed above

h = distance between facing centroids

length of loaded edge of panel

K F + K M (Note: The values for these buckling terms differ


from those given in Sections 3.1.2 and 3.1.3)

3-39
(E_tl_+ E_t2
3) (Elt1+ Eat)
(3.1-15)
KF = 12 (E1t_)(E_t
2) (he) KMo

Or, for equal facings

(tf 2) KM o
(3.1-15a)
KF = 2 h2

where

KM = value ofK M for V=W=0


o

for panel buckling are given in Figures 3.1-25 through 3.1-28 as a func-
Values of K M

These cover panels having


tion of the parameter \T or W, and the panel aspect ratio.

isotropic faceplates using both isotropic and orthotropic cores, including those using

corrugated flute-type cores.

The equations defining the parameters V and W are the same as those given in the

previous section for edgewise compression; however, they are repeated below to

facilitate their use. The equation numbers previously assigned to them are retained

below; however, values of E _ are replaced by those of E for this case.

(Elt _ ) (E2t_) (z) tc


V = (3.1-7)
k (Eit_ + E_t_)(b2 ) G ca

V = 1r_t e Eftf/2k b 2 Gca (equal facings) (3.1-7a)

For a sandwich panel with a corrugated core in which the corrugation flutes are parallel

to the edge of length a, the parameter V is replaced by the parameter W, which is de-

fined as follows :

3-4O
C
w = (3.1-8)
I b_Gcb (Elh +E2t _)

Or, for equalfacings,

W = _r_tc Eft/2X b 2 Geb (3.1-8a)

A particular design may be checked by using the graphs given in Figures 3.1-25 through

3.1-28 to determine the appropriate value of the buckling coefficient to use in Equation

(3.1-15), or (3.1-15a) to compute the critical buckling stress, Fer. This approach,

which involves trial and error solutions by iteration, may also be employed to develop

new panel designs; however, this manual recommends that the design-procedures

approach described in Reference 3-1 be considered since it was set up to facilitate

such design caleulations.

3-41
36 ......

_-
°°°I
C _-- _|_T

2
32 ?r D
V --
V--0
b2 U

28 .......

I
r

/
"_ n--2/ n--3
24

16

V=0.215
i
8
FOR v => 0.21_ KM = 1.ssG/v

0
o 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0
a b
b a

Figure 3.1-25. K M for a Simply Supported Sandwich Panel with an


Isotropic Core, (R = 1.00)

3-42
4O
a -------_

G _
e c, ,, |
3_

y2 D
V -
b2 U
32 !V=0

A
/

_4 ! ", n=l S
f
n=2vxn=3

,o "X v=o.osl

16 \ \_.
\
\

12

-'_..L--
o.2
8

V--0 .4
I I----

FOR V _-
> 0.4 K M -- 1. ss6/v

0
0 0.2 0.4 0.6
{ I
0.8 1.0 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0
a b
b a

Figure 3.1-26. K M for a Simply Supported Sandwich Panel with an


Orthotropic Core, (R = 2.50)

3-43
4O

36

2 D
32
V=0 V --

2
b U

28

K
M

0.15

FOR V >0
15 KM= 1.886/V

0
0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0
a b
b a

Figure 3.1-27. KM for a Simply Supported Sandwich Panel with an


Orthotropic Core, (R = 0.40)

3-44
4O
v cr rl a-----_

36 G --_ 'i
±
y2t D
e
32
b2h 2 Gcb

28
Ill/ \
"_.. n=21 n=3
24---

W=O.05

2O

W=0.20
16

_W=0.50
12

............ L .......................

C
0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0
a b
b a

Figure 3.1-28. K M for a Simply Supported Sandwich Panel with Corrugated Core.
Core Corrugation Flutes Parallel to Side a

3-45
3.1.5 OtherSingleLoadingConditions

A searchof the literature, aswell as contactswith a numberofpeoplewhohavebeen

activein the analyticalmethodsfield for this type of construction,revealednoother

singleloadingconditionswhichmight leadto panelinstability problems. Consequently,

the previously'describedloadingconditionsrepresentthe extentof the fiat panelsta-

bility datawhichwill begivenherefor individualloadingcases.

3-46
3.1.6 Combined Loading Conditions

3.1.6.1 Basic Principles

A study of the effects of combined loadings on the buckling of fiat sandwich panels

requires the consideration of a number of factors. Some are:

a. The mode of failure of the panel under each of the applied loads.

b. The interaction between different modes for precipitation of panel

buckling or failure.

c. The influence of variations in the core shear rigidity values on the

interaction equations for panel instability failure under combined

loadings.

Since little specific testing for biaxial instability modes has been accomplished for

fiat sandwich panels, this part of the manual will provide analytically developed

equations for combination of the stress ratios which are conservative for most appli-

cations. Additionally, some discussion of the considerations involved is included

along with appropriate references in case more specific solutions or background is

needed.

The equations given on the following pages cover the interaction relationships between

the stress ratios, (R i = Ni/Nicr) , for each of the separate loadings which produce

failure by overall panel instability under the action of the combined loads. For the

stress ratio relationships which produce panel failure by local instability only, refer

to Section 2. These latter equations and pertinent discussion are not repeated here

3--47
although the specific equation number and report page are listed below for each of the

local instability modes:

a. Intracellular Buckling: Equation (2.1-6), Page 2-7.

b. Face Wrinkling (Asymmetric): Equation (2.2-6), Page 2-26.

c. Face Wrinkling {Symmetric): Equation (2.2-15), Page 2-35.

It should be noted that there are no known data available for potential panel failures

which might occur as a result of interaction between a local instability situation

arising from the loading applied along one edge in conjunction with a general insta-

bility problem arising from the loading applied along the panel edge perpendicular

to the first one. This situation might occur for panels having very high aspect

ratios; however, most of these would also indicate a potential local instability failure

under the action of the combined loads. In all cases, however, as has been previously

noted, tests should be run to substantiate a final design in all cases where there is

some question as to the structural adequacy of the sandwich component.

The effects of plasticity must be accounted for in calculating the stress ratios, R.,i to

be used in the interaction equations which are given in later paragraphs. Reference is

herewith made to the discussion and recommendations given in Section 9.2, COMBINED

LOADING CONDITIONS, in this report and in particular to Equation (9.2-1) or (9.2-1a).

Either of these equations define an effective uniaxial stress, cr., for use in determining
1

an effective plasticity reduction factor which accounts for the effects of the biaxial

stress field. Once the value of (y. is known, the plasticity reduction factor, _7, may
1

be calculated by means of Equation (9.2-3).

3-48
3.1.6.2 Design Equations and Curves

The design equations and curves for combined loading conditions are separated into

those which should be used for sandwich panels having honeycomb cores and those to

be uscd with panels having corrugated cores. Supporting references are given for

each type and loading condition along with any limitations or restrictions on the use

of the interaction equation.

Sandwich Panels with Honeycomb Cores

The interaction relationships between the stress ratios which define the onset of general

instability buckling of honeycomb core panels under combined loadings are complex

functions of a number of factors. Some of these will be covered briefly here. One of

the prerequisites for the development of the interaction equation is the determination

of the number of half-waves in both the x and y directions for minimum energy plate

buckling. Since each of these is a function of not only its relationship with the other

but is also dependent upon the core shear rigidity parameter, V, the panel aspect

ratio, panel edge support considerations, etc., the establishment of general equations

covering all of these influences presents a formidable problem.

In view of the complexity involved in an exact definition of combined load interactions,

the writers of this manual propose the use of the following simplified stress ratio

relationships for panel buckling. These give somewhat conservative results over the

typical range of aerospace application and have been recommended for general use,

[3-I].

3 -49
A° Biaxial Compression. The following formula is recommended for estimating

buckling of a panel subjected to biaxial compression:

R +R =1 (3.1-16)
cx cy

where

R = N/N
e cr

N = Loading along panel edge, lbs/inch.

N = Critical loading along panel edge, lbs/inch. (See Equation


cr
3.1-1,)

x, y = Subscripts denoting direction of loading. (See Figure 3.1-1.)

A plot of Equation (3.1-16) is given in Figure 3.1-29 to facilitiate its use in

making design checks.

As noted in References 3-1 and 3-23, the above equation is correct for square,

isotropic sandwich panels for which V _ 0. It becomes appreciably conservative

for panels of large aspect ratio, (a/b _ 3.0) and for panels bordering on the weak

core regime (V _> 0.3). For panels with aspect ratios of 2.0 or less, and which

have reasonably stiff honeycomb cores, Equation (3.1-16) provides a satisfactory

method for prediction of the onset of panel buckling.

Bo Bending and Compression. Equation (3.1-17) provides a sufficiently reliable

method for the estimation of panel buckling under the action of combined bending

and compression loads.

R + (RBx)3/2 = 1 (3.1-17)
CX

3-50
where

(See definition of Terms for Equation 3.1-16.)


Rc = N/Ncr

RB = (N/Ncr)bending

N = Load per unit width of edge due to edgewise bending, lbs/in.

N Critical edgewise loading on panel due to bending moment,


cr
lbs/in. (See Equation 3.1-13.)

Figure (3.1-30) plots the interaction relationship given by Equation (3.1-17) to

enable its ready use.

References 3-19 and 3-23 are recommended, in case more accurate analysis

of this loading combination is desired.

C. Compression and Shear. The following interaction formula furnishes a depend-

able method for the prediction of panel buckling under this particular combination

of loads:

Rc + (Rs)2 = 1 (3.1-18)

whe re

Re = N/Ncr (See definition of terms for Equation 3.1-16.)

RS = (Ns/Nsc r)

N = Shear loading per unit width of panel edge, lbs/in.


s

N = Critical edgewise shear loading, lbs/in. (See Equation 3.1-9.)


ser

Equation (3.1-18) is plotted in Figure 3.1-31 to enable it to be more easily used

in the solution of specific problems. References 3-21 and 3-23 develop this

interaction relationship in greater depth for those needing this information.

3-51
O_ Bending and Shear. The following interaction equation represents a close

approximation of tile buckling behavior of panels under combined edgewise

bending and shear loads.

(3.1-19)
(RB)2+ (Rs)2 = 1

w he r c

R These terms are defined as before for


B = (N/Ner)bending
Equation (3.1-1 7).

Rs = (Ns/Nscr) As previously defined for Equation (3.1-18).

Again, as for the previous combined loadings, Equation (3.1-19) is plotted in

Figure 3.1-32 to make it more easily and readily usable. Reference 3-19 pro-

vides additional background information on the development of this interaction

equation.

Sandwich Panels with Corrugated Cores

The interaction equations for predicting the onset of general instability failure for

sandwich panels with corrugated cores involve the consideration of a number of com-

plex relationships also, as for the honeycomb core case. The same influences prevail

for fluted corrugations as before, with the additional consideration that the core shear

modulus normal to the direction of flute orientation is negligible in comparison to the

shear modulus measured parallel to the flutes. Also, the ability of the corrugations

to carry axial loading when it is applied along the axis of the flutes, further compli-

cates the problem since the distribution of this loading between the faceplates and the

flutes depends on the geometry and material thicknesses.

3-52
In view of the magnitude of the problem involved in developing specific equations for

the interaction relationships, this manual will take advantage of the extensive studies

in this area performed by Harris and Auelman, [3-14 and 3-16]. The latter reference

presents interaction equations for the prediction of the onset of panel buckling in the

form'of curves relating the buckling coefficients to each other as a function of panel

aspect ratio, the core bending-shear rigidity parameter, W, the _!ation between load

direction and flute orientation, and the ratio of the loading carried by the flutes with

respect to that carried by the faceplates. These interaction curves are repeated here

in Figures 3.1-33 through 3.1-42 for several values of the shear rigidity parameter,

W, and for the following additional relationships: 1) Panel aspect ratio, a/b = 1/2,

1.0, and 2.0, and 2) Amount of axial load carried by the core corrugations is negligible

(D = bending stiffness
with respect to that carried by the faceplates, i.e., De/D = 0. c

of corrugations, and D = bending stiffness of sandwich panel.)

A discussion of each of the sets of interaction curves follows.

Ao Biaxial Compression. Interaction curves relating the buckling coefficients for

this combined load condition are given in Figures 3.1-33 through 3.1-35.

Buckling coefficients for other panel aspeo* ratios and different values of W

may be obtained by interpolation.

The following example problem is offered to demonstrate how these curves may

be used to predict the onset of panel buckling.

Given: Panel withN =2000 lbs/in, N =400 lbs/in, a=30 in, b-- 60 in,
x y

D = 3.0 × 10 _ lbs/in e, use W = 0 for example problem.

3-53
Figure3.1-33 is usedfor this casesince(a/b) = 1/2. The top line of this figure

applies since W = 0. The interaction equation takes the following general form:

R + R <_1 (3.1-20)
cx cy

or

N N
x y
+ __ 1 (3.1-21)
N N
xcr ycr

where

= Stress ratios for loads in subscript directions, dimensionless.


Rcx'Rcy

N = Critical panel loading for loading applied in the x direction, =


xcr
(rr_/b _) (Kx) (D), lbs per inch.

N = Critical panel loading for the y direction, = (rr_/b _) (%) (D),


ycr
lbs per inch.

K,K Buckling coefficients for loading parallel to the subscript


x y direction.

E; (tf)(t e + tf) 2
D = Sandwich bending stiffness = for equal facings.
2 (1 _Nfe)

W = _r_ (t c) (EO (tf)/2 (1 -_Zfe) (b 2) Gcb for equal facings.

Ef ' = Effective Young's modulus for faces, psi.

Gcb -- Core shear modulus in the direction parallel to the flutes, psi.

t = Thickness of core, inches.


C

tf = Thickness of faceplates, inches.

_Zf = Poisson's ratio of faceplates.

a,b = Panel dimensions, inches.

3-54
Substitutingin Equation(3.1-21):

N N
X Y
+ 1.0 (3.1-22)

(K x) (_) D/b _) (%) (_'_D/b2)

and, letting

r = N /N (3.1-23)
y x

then

(3.1-24)
Nxb_ [ 1 r]

Since D, b, N , and r will be known for the design in question, and K and K
x x y

may be obtained from the appropriate curve, Equation (3.1-24) can be used in

checking the panel stability on the basis that the panel margin of safety is the

same for each loading direction. Thus,

(M.S.)x = (M.S.) Y (3.1-25)

From which

(_) 1o:(_yc4
.Nx.
lO \Ny/

or

= r (3.1-26)
Nxer/ =

the n

(Ky) (y2D/b 2) KY
-----r - (3.1-27)
K
(Kx) (_'_D/b _) x

3-55
Returningto the datagivenfor the exampleproblemto demonstratethe method

for checkingpanelstability:

r = N /N = (400/2000) = 0.20
y x

K /K = 0.20, from Equation (3.1-27)


y x

Using Figure 3.1-33, erect a line passing through the origin and having a slope

of K /K = 0.20 and extend it until it intersects the line for W = 0. The coor-
y x

dinates of this intersection point, as taken from the figure, are: K = 6.0,
X

and K = 1.2.
Y

Then,

N = K (_2D/bZ) = (6.0) (_r_ × 3.0 × 102/602 )


xcr X

N = (6.0)(822.0) = 4930 lbs/inch


xer

N = K (_r_D/b 2) = (1.2)(822.0) = 986 lbs/inch


ycr y

Solving Equation (3.1-21) for a panel stability check:

2000 400
- 0.406 + 0.406 =: 0.812
4930 986

Since the total is less than 1.0, the panel is stable under the applied loads. The

margin of safety for panel buckling is: M.S. = (1.0/0.812) - 1.0 = +0.232.

3-56

Combined Compression Along Core Flutes and Shear. Figures 3.1-36 through

3.1-38 give eurves showing the interaction relationships between the buckling

coefficients for panels loaded in this manner. Curves for other panel aspect

ratios and values of the shear rigidity parameter may be developed by inter-

polation from those given. Panel stability checks for this combined loading

condition are made in the same manner as for the biaxial compression ease.

This is accomplished by handling the calculations for the t2 term in the inter-
s

action equation in the same way as was done for the I_ term in the example
cy

given on page 3-53.

C, Combined Compression Normal to Core Flutes and Shear. Interaction curves

for the buckling coefficients covering this particular combination of loads are

given in Figures 3.1-39 through 3.1-41. These curves may be interpolated to

obtain values for the specific design under study and the stability checks may

be made in a similar fashion to those for the biaxial compression case. The

method to be used in performing design checks on panels loaded in this manner

is the same as that noted in item (B) above.


Combined Biaxial Compression and Shear. Figure 3.1-42 shows the relation-

ships for the compression and shear buckling coefficients for this loading con-

dition. These curves are for a square panel only, however, as may be noted

from the small change in the values of K between the various values of the
Y

shear rigidity parameter, W, approximate interpolations may be made on the

basis of ratios obtained from the curves of Figures 3.1-36 through 3.1-38.

3-57
Panelstability checksare madein basicallythe samemanneras for the example

problemgivenonpage3-53, exceptthatthe stress ratio, Rcy, is handleddiffer-

ently. Thebasic interactionequationfor this conditiontakesthe following

generalform:
R +R +R _1
cx cy s
where
R andR are as definedonpage3-54.
cx cy

Rs = (N xy/Nscr ) = [Nxy /(_/b 2) (Ks) (D)]

K = buckling coefficient for shear


s

Since, as may be seen in Figure 3.1-42, K is a function of W only for this case
Y

and is independent of the values of Kx and Ks, the value for Rcy may be calcu-

lated imm :diately and the interaction equation put in the following form:

Rcx + Rs = (1.0- Rcy ) : Or, Rcx +Rs = C

The design check may now be performed in the same way as for the example

problem on page 3-53, if the R term and calculations are handled in the same
s

way as the R term and calculations were handled for the example. It is to be
cy

noted, however, that the term on the right side of the equation, C, has a value

which is less than 1.0 and this value should be used in place of the 1.0 used in

the example. Thus, assumingR = 0.10, then C = 1.0 -0.1 =0.9, and the
cy

margin of safety for panel buckling as calculated on page 3-57 for the example

would now become:

M.S. = (0.90/0.812)- 1.0 = +0.109

3-58
R
cx

0.6 0.8
0 0.2 0.4 R
cy

Figure 3.1-29. Interaction Curve for a Honeycomb Core Sandwich


Panel Subjected to Biaxial Compression

3-59
1.0_::: hi !': ft+.
....
....
I
+ +
::
,
t;+
'++ ....
.... _it_
+P+_ :i!: if!! _'_ |
i.
+++.
Itt _:
: ' +i ' +_+ P [ il +r + ;i,-
'::;::.t ....... T++[ "I :'
r!','_T !_ !! !'
;I fl ::::I::::
i,+!t
: ;:{!:..
t_+:

....
: ,:

: ,:--!:
,_!_ _ _
!_ilii!:

,,_i,],,i
+i::

:::

: ::"
'

_!i+ i I i! .i.. :fill+: !:i :':i ;:. ::+_lli-'ii_


:+'i: +- i_ _i i!
,,, i:+
:::: til + +_ :,-:::
" "+ :
!i"
o.8i!.!!!...ii::i
:ii i_ i '

_+fl .... i+ .
![;:
:iiii:i: il!i ::-t:l '+li_li:i: :_
II + --.+v'":=;!: ;:,- tit, , + +:;
++' 111 i':,: '+

::i 1! ?} r :::-::::,:ii !]ii _ !_!il!i[i ++:_


_t t[
Ittt]t::iit :: _!:iii!L
+;++I+ ......
:+++: _i_ +,+
+.
+P_

+!t+l+++:
:'.'.i +:': +!+ ;+++t!G:_
',',+
...... ::--i , ,+_ +_+ N_:
0.6 lll.+'.l; _'.| ',t:

.rg_!!i!!:Fi:i i;I H. N_!! (Rcx


ii "
ii[" + RBx 3/2 : 1.0):_,+.
It !!! _i: .,+.
,_ i!i lii:
CX _; | ' I ::"' _' _t_'l][t JJl.
+_I :....... +4,)
1+ ?f Irt++'P_+l?': !:++ fff+l_+'f ....
144 ;4 _++ ] ,+| :::

0.4 ":r !!
.la
:'I!
I.
I+++++N
+:
.......
: : _bJ::!+`:!ti:ifill+ +::"

++:I++++I++++:N
: : +++:+_,,,
_,++If+1+ +
',_tt++,

ttTT

0.2 tit tf: !t r! T[


....... + +!+_
+ !+I++++
F_F!i!!!i:_ TTC_
+4++t++++t+!i+
+1++FiHtN
. ...... ;Ut

iii tr _
t!t:Ir _ +|:tr [[i[ ' '
_t_;t:'+:: itt_ "_]_ It l_tt I i!::
!-F i:
U4ttt!iiilii!t
0 Hf+H_ii_t+xl _ ]PI tt 11 Pt ii _t!,_ii!l
I _++_!d+:]l+_fi..
o 0.2 0°4 0. 6 o. 8 1. o
R
Bx

Figure 3.1-30. Interaction Curve for a Honeycomb Core Sandwich


Panel Subjected to Bending and Compression

3-60
I!+t:: : +!:iii _!< i! !;;

- [![ ' !1 ....


_ ,, ii:
![![i[I

+':t!tlii! !i'. t!'.: ;;:: [b!:


_iiil
_;t ii :_i ilti !!!: tr_r,i; ,,_+.:

tt _i::
:_ i_ tR + R = 1 O) "TrY
i[ _:i _ c s "
ii! I[ :t_l liT! T.... :: ,lii:*+
gt
++ _!!1
+,+l

. _ : ;+ t_; !_

R
2 .: .- , ]q[ _I_ + , ii

1I....
tti_
Jill
C !! iTii
+÷,. _':_it:_l}_
l;ii _.XiitiliaS:.-!i I ¸ !_i

';' t;t: tell :::?='¢tii _!" i

i: !i!!
' !111

::;ilf!+ ::',. :::;+,+u m;:


:I1iI2:; ::;; +.1!!Ill: '_+ +:i.... 1tit
4 4;;;

r!t !!! r i}_+ _iii!!iT:!!!+! L +:_i

+ , I i , , + i ' _ ' 4 =1 " : l r t! f1 t _ ] i , '

i]4!ti!i::;;i:_i;I +t_;liilli) t_
Lilt
t;:i
L+ '.1+
!+'.,.J,i
........ ;++_ ++++i;+++++l++ 11
!+,+:t;;_p.+!:_i-]-Ll ++ L !![

;i 1%I:
,+++i;+11++1+Pl_+_
+ H _ t_

0.6 0.8 1,0


R
S

Figure 3.1-31. Interaction Curve for a Honeycomb Core Sandwich


Panel Subjected to Compression and Shear

3-61
Figure 3.1-32. Interaction Curve for a Honeycomb Core Sandwich
Panel Subjected to Bending and Shear

3-62
20.0 Y

N ___ +. b
x
16.0

W=0
L...×
-tttt _
N

12.0
\ i
Y
Nb
2
X
W = 0.05 K
X 2
_r D
K
Y
N b2
Y
. Z = --
8.0 y 2
D

I
W = 0.20-

4.0
(a/b = 1/2)

I
W 0.50-

\
4.0 6.0 8.0
0 2.0
K
X

Figure 3.1-33. Buckling Coefficients for Corrugated Core Sandwich


Panels in Biaxial Compression (a/b = 1/2)

3-63
5.0

Figure 3.1-34. Buckling Coefficients for Corrugated Core Sandwich


Panels in Biaxial Compression (a/b = 1.0)

3-64
2.0
Y l
L a _1
I- -I

N
X
b

1.6

N
_'_ Y N b2

K
X
D
2
1.2

K - 2

K
Y
\ I

0.8
w \ "-,g_,. I
"_...... -.., \'_
O. 50 --_

0.4

(a/b = 2. O) _ _ \_

o
0 1.0 2.0 3.0 4.0

K
X

Figure 3.1-35. Buckling Coefficients for Corrugated Core Sandwich


Panels in Biaxial Compression (a/b = 2.0)

3-65
10.0
y_
"k- 4
N '-_" b 4.._ b
X
-"_---4
8.0

(a/b = 1/2)
xy 2
Nb

I K
X
x2D

6.o __ 2
N b
xy
K
K _ \ S
2D
× \ "_,

4.0
\
\ \\ \

W = 0
2.0

W=0.20 - ..W = O. 05

0
0 8.0 16.0 24.0 32.0
K
S

Figure 3.1-36. Buckling Coefficients for Corrugated Core Sandwich


Panels Under Combined Longitudinal Compression
and Shear with Longitudinal Core (a/b = 1/2)

3-66
4.0
Y a _1

N _ b

3.0
x ' "K = x

_ x 2D2

K
X

2.0

_
\ g1>w\_--io.
o_
w_-o._o
\ jA%
1.0

w=o. o_l \ ,w:o


(a/b = 1.0)

0 2.0 4.0 6.0 8.0 10. O

K
S

Figure 3.1-37. Buckling Coefficients for Corrugated Core Sandwich


Panels Under Combined Longitudinal Compression
and Shear with Longitudinal Core (a/b = 1.0)

3-67
5.0
Y,I
a _1
vI

Nx_'_ *-b
(a/b = 2. o) : ...... _ "-
4.0
_ xy

_-_'_ _ ! Nxb2
_'_'\ ff D

_' _ Kx - 2

3.0

Ks _rxy2D
K
X
__ N b2

2.0

.....
1.0
o,,
0
0 2.0 4.0
, 6.0 8.0
K
S

Figure 3.1-38. Buckling Coefficients for Corrugated Core Sandwich


Panels Under Combined Longitudinal Compression
and Shear with Longitudinal Core (a/b = 2.0)

3-68
10.0 •

(a/b = 1/2)

N _
x.... F I t q b
8.0 _t t_

"" ¢-N _" "-32"_" x


xy

i K - N xb 2
6.0 "_ x 2

KX _ 2
_ N b

_, \ Ks xy

4.0

2.0

PW = 0.05 i

I _,
w_o._o- \ '
0 8.0 16. 0 24.0 32.0
K
S

Figure 3.1-39. Buckling C(_fficients for Corrugated Core Sandwich


Panels Under Combined Longitudinal Compression
and Shear with Transverse Core (a/b = 1/2)

3-69
--N f I I I /o__ ' b

Kx
Nbx2
3.0

W= 0. Ir D
N b2

2.0 = 0.05

K
X

_-W=O

1.0
W

(a/b = 1.0) \

0 2.0 4,0 6.0 8.0 10.0


K
S

Figure 3.1-40. Buckling Coefficients for Corrugated Core Sandwich


Panels Under Combined Longitudinal Compression
and Shear with Transverse Core (a/b = 1.0)

3-70
5.0 Y ii
a _1

N x -_ l I l I l _- b
(a/b -- 2.0) ""t.,_
,,,_
, i i i t"-AL..
,,_ X
4.0 \N
xy

I L K -
_x_
x 2
_ D

3.0
N b2

K
\ S
xy
2
17 D
X
\
2.0

05

1.0

w=o._\ _

0 2.0 4.0 6.0 8.0


K
S

Figure 3.1-41. Buckling Coefficients for Corrugated Core Sandwich


Panels Under Combined Longitudinal Compression
and Shear with Transverse Core (a/b = 2.0)

3-71
2.5 Y 1

._e_q_

(a/b : 1. O) Nx ----- = b
2.0

_N_ _ N b2
1.5 Nxy rr D

rr D N b2
K X
N N_ __ Ks =- 2
2_ ' KY - Y
Ky = 1. 7r 2D
1.0 \

K =1.7. W=0

-W = 0.05

0.5

_ 0 50

\i " ()'20 _ __ =_
K 1"9y

o ,_,o 4o oo =o
Ks

Figure 3.1-42. Buckling Coefficients for Corrugated Core Sandwich Panels


Under Combined Longitudinal Compression, Transverse
Compression, and Shear with Longitudinal Core

3-72
3.2 CIRCULARPLATES

3.2.1 AvailableSingleLoadingConditions

A searchof the availableliterature as well as contactswith otherswhoare familiar

with sandwichpanelstability referencesandstudiesin progressuncoveredno stability

solutionsfor anysingleloadingcondition. This result might havebeenanticipated

sincethe flat, circular sandwichplate hasvery few applicationsin aerospacevehicle

structures in whichit mustbestableunderthe appliedloads. Consequently,


this

manualmakesno recommendations
for techniquesto be usedin design, andstrongly

suggeststhatall final configurationsbetestedas requiredto demonstratetheir ade-

quacystructurally.

3.2.2 AvailableCombinedLoadingConditions

Nopanelstability solutionswere foundfor anycombinedloadingconditionsapplicable

to flat, circular platesin the courseof the literature searchnotedin Section3.2.1.

Consequently,
this manualmakesno recommendations
for possibleanalyticalap-

proacheswhichwoulddescribeanystability limits for circular, flat sandwichplates.

3-73
3.3 PLATESWITH CUTOUTS

3.3.1 FramedCutouts

Whileit is highly desirableto avoidcutoutsin aerospacestructuresbecauseof the

attendantweightproblemsas well as uncertaintiesaboutloadpile-up andredistri-

bution, theseare a practical necessitybecauseof accessandother requirementsand

every effort shouldbe madeto derive reliable designapproaches


which minimizethese

drawbacks.

Mostgeneralizedsolutionsfor plateswith cutoutsemployframing membersandbase

the analysisonthe assumptionof buckledskinpanelswhichcarry only shearloads.

Obviously,the solutionbecomesmuchmore complexwhenskin bucklingdoesnot

occur, as wouldbe the casefor a framedcutoutin a sandwichpanel. Despitethe

increasedcomplexity,however,solutionsfor the load distributionaroundthe cutout

canbe obtainedfor variousload applicationsawayfrom the opening. Knowingthe

load distributionadjacentto the cutoutdoesnot necessarilyprovideananswerto all

questionsregardingthe adequacyof the design, however,particularly in the caseof

sandwichconstruction.

In the caseof monocoque


or semi-monocoque
panels, the lateral momentsof inertia

of the framingmembersare generallysufficientlygreaterthanthoseof the skin such

thatthey maybe consideredto providelateral supportfor the paneledge. This is not

necessarilythe casefor sandwichpanels,thus settingupthe caseof a free, or nearly

free, edgefor thepanelandfor whichconditionnogeneralstability solutionsor data

were foundin the courseof this study.

3-74
It maybepossiblefor specificdesignsto be assessed,onthe basisof goodengineering

judgment,to be critical in local instability rather thanfor generalinstability. This

beingthe case, designchecksmaybe madeonthe basisof the equationsgivenin

Section2. This manualmakesno recommendations


for thosecaseswherethe general

instability modeappearsto controlbeyondthe exerciseof goodjudgmentin the devel-

opmentof the design, andsufficient testingas neededto insure its integrity.

3.3.2 UnframedCutouts

Unframedcutoutsin sandwichpanelshaveall of the disadvantages


notedfor framed

cutoutsandrepresenta muchmore seriousdesignproblemlocally, insofar as the

free edgeis concerned. Thewriters of this manualencounteredno instancesin which

sucha designapproachwasusedin primary or secondarystructure and, in general,

recommendavoidanceof this practice. This recommendation


is basednot only onthe

lack of anyanalyticalor test databut alsoonpotentialproblemsof faceplate-corebond

separationalongthe free edgedueto damagewhile in use, adhesivedeterioration,

load cycling, etc.

3-75
+ o
h9

Z
I o .._

,.m _ _.5
0

i
[I r] ._ "_ ,._

,--+

%-i _u o_ +a
0
_ +a oa
.,4

+ii!
,-..i
o,,-I
+..o

,B,

ff

ro o "_ m+ d6
Z
p,-+ ©

,+.9
o
+ +.+B _ Z
[,¢] ,+_ --+ O "+
o+o:_
0
o,,-i

<

Z
8+
c ---...
¢a9

B , B _
0 _ 0 B
o
0 o
% e_ o o b+

b 0 +
o
0
0 0 I

B
©
C.l] _t_ _ "_

Eo_.S
I
o.9

0
m

ryj

3-76
o
fF

o o
E,.b
p.

¢,

tm

©
U H II II II

M m
_i ._ r_

_ +

M E

'1=
H
II

Z _
r..,q I._
o
0 ° 0 _'

o
<:

u II II II [I

,M
0 i-,].

3-77
bJo o
0 01
0

09
.-o_ o_ >
c_
b_

0
_7

7 '-_, °_

o"

E _o °_
0 o o=

.o _ +

tn
r_

o
o r_ Ir

o _
0 ,_ o_ _9

0 !
o
L_

!
Z

0 0
tn

3-78
_9

b_

b_

_o

o
o"

0
0

II

L_ z
0
_o

3-79
...... lr J
g_

_r

_ ,_

god
c,l

t
g
o _ f'--I

•_ ..
gl _
N
o
rj

N J_ -_ _ •

0
L_

I.
o

Z° Z L_._J
Ca

_ _._
II
v
i
I m ×
°

,_,_= ._,

g
°_,1 ,
r/?

k -T

8
,-_ ..o i 0 ,

b'_ _ , 0

__j
'ii £ _:

3-80
_ _ _ o

o _ o_

._ _ o_ _
_ , _.

o _ _ o_

_
0
, _'_

_ o_ _ _._
o _ _ _ _._

°_ _ _ _.-_ o o.
.o _ _ . _
b._ • I o _ _ "_
,._ _ _ _._
0

o _ ._ _ _.
-t

.._ _ _ _ _o

II

o _ ,, __ _4
• _ _ ,__ _ _ ._._

_,_,4 I

L! iJ
l/ \,II

D-

3-81
._..E
_._ o

r_

o
_.

0
L_ e- *') _1
_ _°
_._ _ _._
o_ _ _ _ _._

r._ o
_d

_ z_ ._ _
_ z
m
o o • _ _ "_

Z _ ._ _ _

_' _ z _'

_ °_' _ ° _
M I!

_,_ _ _ ,, _ _ _ m

_ • _ M_ 2_..
_._ _ hi)' i
_._ _:

e_
o

,,,4 8
o - I I o
<
r_
m
m
I I IJ
e_
>._ir-'J , , ' <

u o
z

I
8_

3-82
0
2
0 _ "_

z
_ o.
o _ ._ "___

C
° o_ ,, °_o ._
o_ _ z_ _

._ o° o
o_

_ _ z_
+

_.o C_

Z _ o_ o
c_

II

t_ _ _ 0 2
_o _

o
o xj-F__
I I i I I I_ _
<i

3-83
REFERENCES

3-1 U. S. Department of Defense, "Structural San_vich Composites, " MIL-

HDBK-23, 30 December 1968.

3-2 General Dynamics Fort Wo,__th Division, Structures Manual - Volume 1,

Methods of Analysis, November 1959.

3-3 Konishi, D., et a], Honeycomb Sandwich Structures Manual, North

American Aviation Corp. Los Angeles Division, Report NA58-899.

3-4 Structures Manual - Section 11.00: Honeycomb Sandwich Structures,

North American Aviation, Inc. Space and Information Systems Division,

May 1964.

3-5 Lockheed-Georgia Company, A Division of Lockheed Aircraft Corp.,

"Sandwich Panel Tests for C-5A Airplane," GELAC Report No. ER 8976,

22 February 1967.

3-6 General Dynamics Corporation Forth Worth Division, "Design Allowables

and Methods of Analysis, F-111 Airplane," Report No. FZS-12-141,

1 August 1965.

3-7 Hexcel Corp., "Design Handbook for Honeycomb Sandwich Structures,"

Report No. TSB 123, October 1967.

3-8 Ericksen, W. S. and March, H. W., "Fffects of Shear Deformation in the

Core of a Flat Rectangular Sandwich Panel - Compressive Buckling of

Sandwich Panels Having Dissimilar Facings of Unequal Thickness," Forest

Products Laboratory Report 1583-B, Revised 1958.

3-9 Norris, C. B., "Compressive Buckling Curves for Flat Sandwich Panels

with Isotropic Facings and Isotropic or Orthotropic Cores, " Forest

Products Laboratory Report 1854, Revised 1958.

3-85
3-10 Norris, C. B., "Compressive Buckling Curves for Flat Sandwich Panels

with Dissimilar Facings, " Forest Products Laboratory Report 1875,

September 1960.

3-11 Kuenzi, E. W., Norris, C. B. and Jenkinson, P. M., "Buckling Coeffi-

cients for Simply Supported and Clamped Flat, Rectangular Sandwich Panels

Under Edgewise Compression, " Forest Products Laboratory Research Note

FPL-070, December 1964.

3-12 Jenkinson, P. M. and Kuenzi, E. W., "Buckling Coefficients for Flat,

Rectangular Sandwich Panels with Corrugated Cores Under Edgewise

Compression, " Forest Products Laboratory Research Paper FPL 25,

May 1965.

3-13 Kuenzi, E. W., and Ericksen, W. S., "Shear Stability of Flat Panels of

Sandwich Construction, " Forest Products Laboratory Report 1560, 1951.

3-14 Harris, L. A. and Auelman, R. R., "Stability of Flat, Simply Supported

Corrugated Core Sandwich Plate Under Combined Longitudinal Compression

and Bending, Transverse Compression and Bending, and Shear," North

American Aviation, Inc., Missile Division, Report STR 67, 1959.

3-15 Kimel, W. R., "Elastic Buckling of a Simply Supported Rectangular

Sandwich Panel Subjected to Combined Edgewise Bending and Compression, "

Forest Products Laboratory Report 1857A, 1956.

3-16 Harris, L. A., and Auelman, R. R., "Stability of Flat, Simply Supported

Corrugated Core Sandwich Rectangular Plates Under Combined Loadings,"

Journal of Aerospace Sciences, Vol. 27, No. 7, p. 525-534, 1960.

3-17 Timoshenko, S. P., and Gere, J. M., Theory of Elastic Stability, McGraw-

Hill Book Company, Inc., 1961, p. 373-379.

3-18 Gerard, G., and Becker, H., Handbook of Structural Stability, Part I-

Buckling of Flat Plates, National Advisory Committee for Aeronautics

Technical Note 3781, 1957.

3-86
3-19 Kimel, W. R., "Elastic Bucklingof a SimplySupportedRectangularSand-
wich PanelSubjectedto CombinedEdgewiseBending,Compression,and
Shear," ForestProductsLaboratoryReport1859,1956.

3-20 Noel, R. G., "Elastic Stabilityof SimplySupportedFlat RectangularPlates


UnderCritical Combinationsof LongitudinalBending,LongitudinalCom-
pression, andLateral Compression,"Journalof the AeronauticalSciences,
Vol. 19, No. 12, p. 829-834, 1952.

3-21 Norris, C. B., and Kommers, W. J., "Critical Loads of a Rectangular,

Flat Sandwich Panel Subjected to Two Direct Loads Combined with a Shear

Load," Forest Products Laboratory Report 1833, 1952.

3-22 Norris, C. B., and Kommers, W. J., "Stresses within a Rectangular,

Flat Sandwich Panel Subjected to a Uniformly Distributed Normal Load and

Edgewise, Direct, and Shear Loads, " Forest Products Laboratory Report

1838, 1953.

3-23 Plantema, F. J., Sandwich Construction, John Wiley and Sons, Inc., New

York, 1966.

3-24 U. S. Department of Defense, "Plastics for Flight Vehicles: Part I, Rein-

forced Plastics, " MIL-HDBK-17, Armed Forces Supply Support Center,

1959, Available from U. S. Government Printing Office, Washington, D. C.

3-25 U. S. Department of Defense, "Metallic Materials and Elements for Aero-

space Vehicle Structures," MIL-HDBK-5A, February 1966, Available from

U. S. Government Printing Office, Washington, D. C.

3-87
4
GENERAL INSTABILITY OF CIRCULAR CYLINDERS

4.1 GENERAL

In the case of axially compressed, thin-walled, isotropic (non-sandwich) cylinders, it

has long been recognized that test results usually fall far below the predictions from

classical small-deflection theory [4-1]. These discrepancies are usually attributed

primarily to

a. the shape of the post-buckling equilibrium path coupled with the presence

of initial imperfections

and

b. the fact that classical small-deflection theory does not account for pre-

buckling discontinuity distortions in the neighborhood of the boundaries.

Neglecting the discontinuity distortions, the equilibrium path for an axially com-

pressed perfect cylinder is of the general shape shown by the solid curve in Figure

4.1-1. This path is linear until point A is reached and general instability occurs at

a stress level crCL equal to the result from classical small-deflection theory

[ °'eL - R _/3(1-Ve _) for elastic, isotropic (non-sandwich) cylinders However, if

the cylinder is initially imperfect and the discontinuity distortions are considered, the

behavior will be as shown by curve 0B and buckling will occur at the stress O'cr. The

rrtio (Crcr/erCL) will be dependent upon the magnitude of the initial imperfections pres-

ent in the cylinder. However, since this information is not normally available, one

4-1
usuallyfinds it necessaryto resort to either of the followingpracticesto obtainpracti-
cal designvalues:

a. Setthe allowablecompressivestress equalto the valuecrMi N shown in

Figu_e 4. i-I.

b. Use the classical small-deflection value o-CL in conjunction with a suitable

knock-down factor )'e which is based on the results from a large array of

test data. The allowable compressive stress is then obtained from

(rcr = )'c_CL (4.1-I)

Perfect
Cylinder
A Imperfect
crCL Cylinder

Axial
Compressive
Stress
O'cr
C

O'MiN

0
End Shortening

Figure 4.1-1. Equilibrium Paths for Axially


Compressed Circular Cylinders

For isotropic (non-sandwich) cylinders it is common practice to follow the second of

these approaches and, for such cylinders, the test data shows that _'c is a function of

the radius-to-thickness ratio (R/t).

4-2
In the caseof sandwichcylindershavingrelatively rigid cores, the behavioris similar

to that of the isotropic (non-sandwich)


cylinder andonecanexpectimperfectionsand

boundarydisturbancesto precipitategeneralinstability at compressivestressesbelow

the predictionsfrom classical small-deflectionsandwichtheory, ttowever, in most

practical applications,the sandwichwall will provide aneffectiverelatively thick shell

so thatthe discrepancieswill not be as large as thosenormally encountered


in thin-

walledisotropic (non-sandwich)
cylinders. In addition,as the coretransverseshear

rigidity decreases,the differencesbetweentest results andclassicalpredictionswill

diminish. In the extremecasewhereshearcrimping occurs, initial imperfectionsdo

not appearto haveanyinfluence.

Oneof the mostprominentof the early designcriteria developedfor axially compressed

circular sandwichcylindersis that of Reference4-2. This solutionemployedlarge-

deflectiontheorytogetherwith approach(a) cited above(Crcr= °'MIN). However, it is

now rather generally agreed that this criterion often provides design values which are

too conservative. In addition, the theoretical development of Reference 4-3 indicates

that CrMi N can be decreased to essentially zero by including a sufficient number of

terms in the large-deflection displacement functions. Therefore, in recent years, it

has become common practice to design sandwich cylinders by method (b) cited above

[4-4 and 4-5]. This approach, which employs small-deflection theory in conjunction

with an empirical knock-down factor, is likewise followed in this handbook.

In the treatment of various types of external loading, it is important to note that the

characteristics of the equilibrium paths are not identical for cases of axial compres-

sion, torsion, or external radial pressure. For purposes of comparison, Figure 4.1-2

4-3
depictsthe generalshapesof thesepathsfor eachloadingcondition[4-6] assuming

that the cylindersare initially perfect andthatnodiscontinuitydistortions are present.

Deflection Deflection Deflection


Axial Compression Torsion ExternalPressure

Figure 4.1-2. Typical Equilibrium Pathsfor Circular Cylinders

Basedonthe relative shapesof thesecurves, onewouldexpectthat, undertorsion or

externalpressure, the cylinderswouldbemuchless sensitiveto initial imperfections

thanin the caseof axial compression. This has beenborneout by the availabletest

datafrom thin-walledisotropic (non-sandwich)


cylinders.

4-4
4.2 AXIAL COMPRESSION

4.2.1 Basic Principles

4.2.1.1 Theoretical Considerations

The theoretical basis used here is the classical small-deflection solution of Zahn and

Kuenzi [4-7] which includes the follox_ing assumptions:

a. The facings are isotropic but the core may have orthotropic transverse

shear properties.

b. Bending of the facings about their own middle surfaces can be neglected.

c. The core has infinite extensional stiffness in the direction normal to the

facings.

d. The core e×_tensional and shear rigidities are negligible in directions

parallel to the facings.

e. The cylinder is not extremely short (a quantitative limit is specified in

Section 4.2.2).

f. The approximations of Donnell [4-8] can be applied without introducing sig-

nific ant error.

In this handbook, the final equations of Reference 4-7 have been transformed into

equivalent formulations which should be more meaningful to the user. For those cases

where the core shear moduli satisfy the condition

Gxz
O- _;1 (4.2-1)
Gyz

the following expression is obtained:

_cr = Kc(ro (4.2-2)

4-5
where

h 2 _r}-_l t 2
(4.2-3)
_o = _Ef--_ l_:-_ee (tl + t_)

and

1
When Vc _ 2 (4.2-4)
Kc = 1 - -_- V c

1
When Vc > 2
Kc = V--c (4.2-5)

where
o-o
Vc - (4.2-6)
°'crimp

5 2

(4.2-7)
_rcrim p - (t 1 + t2)t c Gxz

z
Plasticity reduction factor, dimensionless.

E f= Young' s modulus of facings, psi.

h= Distance between middle surfaces of facings, inches.

R= Radius to middle surface of cylindrical sandwich, inches.

t andt_ = Thicknesses of the facings (There is no preference as to which


facing is denoted by the subscript 1 or 2.), inches.

ue = Elastic Poisson' s ratio of facings, dimensionless.

tc = Thickness of core, inches.

Gxz --
Core shear modulus associated with the plane perpendicular to
the facings and oriented in the axial direction, psi.

Gy z = Core shear modulus associated with the plane perpendicular to


the axis of revolution, psi.

The relationship between Kc and Vc can be plotted as shown in Figure 4.2-1. It is

important to note that the value V c = 2.0 establishes a dividing line between two

different types of behavior. The region where V c _ 2.0 covers the so-called stiff-core

4-6
1.0

K c

I
I
I
2.0

Vc

Figure 4.2-1. Schematic Representation of Relationship


Between Kc and Vc for 0_< 1

and moderately-stiff-core sandwich constructions When Ve is in the neighborhood of

zero, the core shear stiffness is high and the sandwich exhibits maximum sensitivity to

initial imperfections. Hence, for any given radius-to-thickness ratio, the knock-down

factors applicable to such constructions are of maximum severity. As Ve increases

from zero to a value of 2.0, the sensitivity to Imperfections beeomes progressively

less. The domain where V c > 2.0 is the so-called weak-core region where shear

crimping occurs. Sandwich constructions which fall within this category are not influ-

enced by the presence of initial imperfections, and a knock-down factor of unity ean be

applied to such structures. It should be possible to develop a continuous transitional

knock-down relationship which recognizes the variable influence of the core rigidity but

this is beyond the scope of the present handbook.

4-7
4.2.1.2 Empirical Knock-DownFactor

Asnotedin Section4.1, the allowablestress intensitiesfor axially compressed,thin-

walled, isotropic (non-sandwich)


cylinders areusually computedusingthefollo_ving

equation:

_cr = _c °-cL (4.2-8)

The quantity Yc is referred to as the knock-down factor and this value is generally

recognized to be a function of the radius-to-thickness ratio (R/t). Various investi-

gators have proposed different relationships in this regard. The differences arise out

of the chosen statisticalcriteria and/or out of the particular test data selected as the

empirical basis. One of the most widely used of the relationships proposed to date is

the lower-bound criterion of Seide, et al. [4-9] which can be expressed as follows:

}c = 1 - 0.901(1 - e -¢) (4.2-9)

where

1 R
(4.2-10)

This gives a knock-down curve of the general shape depicted in Figure 4.2-2. For the

purposes of this handbook, it is desired that an empirical means of this type also be

provided for the design of sandwieh cylinders. One of the major obstacles to the

achievement of this objeetivo, is the lack of sufficient sandwich test data for a thorough

empirieal determination. Faced with this deficiency, one finds it expedient to employ

the data from isotropie (non-sandwich) cylinders in conjunction with an effective thick-

ness concept and eorrection factors which are based on the few available sandwich test

points. Toward this end, it is usually assumed that, when V c _< 2.0, equal sensitivity

4-8
1.0

Yc

Log Scale

Figure 4.2-2. Semi-Logarithmic Plot of YC vs R/t for Isotropie (Non-


Sandwich) Cylinders Under Axial Compression

to imperfections results from equivalence of the shell-wall radii of gyration p

h
(_ _ for sandwich constructions whose two facings are of equal thickness). There-

fore, the approach taken here is to rewrite Equations (4.2-9) and (4.2-10) in terms

of P. The revised formulations give the plot shown as a dashed curve in Figure

4.2-3. Also sho_ in this figure are the appropriate test points obtained from

axially compressed sandwich cylinders [4-2, 4-10, 4-28] which did not fall into

the weak-core category. Eleven such data points are shown. In addition, two

test points are shown for axially compressed conical sandwich constructions

[4-10] which likewise did not lie in the weak-core region. The conical data are

included in Figure 4.2-3 in view of the scarcity of available test results and

also because the cones were analyzed as equivalent cylinders whose radii were

taken equal to the Rz (finite principal radius of curvature) values at the small end

of the specimens. Based on this limit_i amount of sandwich test data, it is recom-

mended that the solid curve of Figul"e 4.2-3 be used for design purposes. This

4-9
1.0

.8

.7

.6

.3

.2

.1

10 103

Figure 4.2-3. Knock-Down Factor Yc for Circular Sandwich


Cylinders Subjected to Axial Compression

4-10
gives Ycvaluesthat are 75percentof thoseobtainedfrom the dashedcurve whichwas

basedonthe empirical formulaof ,':_eide,


eta]. [4-9].

In additionto the test results describedabove,a considerablenumberof test points

are availablefrom cylindrical sandwichconstructionswhichfall into the weak-core

classification. Asnotedin Section4.2.1.1, the methodsrecommended


in this hand-

bookare suchthat, in the weak-coreregion, no empirical reductionwill be applied

to the theoreticalresults of Reference4-7. In order to explorethe validity of this

approach,plots are furnishedin Figures4.2-4 and4.2-5 whichcomparethe weak-

core test results of References4-2 and4-11againstpredictionsfrom the recom-

mendeddesigncriterion. It canbe seenthat all but oneof the test results exceed

the predictedstrengths,andthatthe singleexceptionfailed at 86percentof the pre-

dictedvalue. In manyof the caseswhere (O-CrTest/O-Predicted)


> 1.0, althoughthe
discrepanciesmeasuredin units of psi werenot very great, thepercentagediffer-

enceswerequitelarge. This behaviorcanbe explainedby the fact that the theoreti-

cal basis [4-7] proposedin this handbookassumesthat bendingof the facingsabout

their ownmiddle surfacescanbe neglected. As shownin Reference4-12, this

assumptioncanbe very conservativein the weak-coreregion. However,in the

interest of simplicity, the methodsof this handbookretain this assumptionespecially

sinceit is a conservativepractice andmostpractical sandwichconstructionswill not

bedesignedas weak-corestructures.

In view of the meager compressive test data available from stiff-core and moderately-

stiff-core sandwich cylinders, the method proposed here is not very reliable when

4-11
Vc < 2.0. Therefore, in suchcasesthe methodcanonlybe consideredas a "best-

available"approach. On the other hand, where the failure is by shear crimping

(V c _>2.0), the method is quite reliable and will, in fact, usually give conservative

predictions.

2O

15

• _,_b.

10 8

_D

Test Data from Reference 4-2

I I
5 10 15 20

Predicted O'cr, ksi

(Neglecting bending stiffness of individual facings)

Figure 4.2-4. Comparison of Proposed Design Criterion Against Test Data for Weak-
Core Circular Sandwich Cylinders Subjected to Axial Compression

4-12
2OO

Test Point from


Reference 4-11
lOO

100 200

Predicted Crcr , ksi

(Neglecting bending stiffness


of individual facings)

Figure 4.2-5. Comparison of Proposed Design Criterion Against


a Test Result for a Weak-Core Circular Sandwich
Cylinder Subjected to Axial Compression

4.2.1.2.1 Interpretation of Test Data

As indicated in the preceding paragraphs, appropriate test data must be used in order

to arrive at practical values for the knock-down factor. However, one can be easily

misled in this endeavor when the test data and/or the classical theoretical predictions

lie in the inelastic region. To demonstrate this point as simply as possible, the pre-

sent discussion is limited to the case of axially compressed circular sandwich cylin-

ders for which V c = 0. Then the recommended design value for the critical stress

can be expressed as follows:

h 2 _ t_ (4.2-11)
°'cr = Yc _ Ef R I_Z-Y-Ye2 (tl + t2)

4-13
For anyparticular test specimen,the relatedvaluefor the knock-downfactor shouldbe

computedfrom the followingexpressionwhichis obtainedby a simpletranspositionof

Equation (4.2-11):

C(rCrTest_
\ "_Test /
= (4.2-12}

(YC)Test [E fRh 2vf_-lt_(t_


_ t_) ]

The plasticity reduction factor DTest is evaluated at the actual experimental buckling

stress. By inspection of the numerator and denominator of Equation (4.2-12), one can

conclude that this formula may be rewritten in the following more meaningful form:

wEXperimental critical stress value]


hich would have been attained had]
the material remained elastic ]
(Yc)Test _lassical theoretical critical" (4.2-13)
| stress value assuming the
L behavior to be elastic

The example illustrated in Figure 4.2-6 should help to clarify this concept. In this

figure, the solid line represents the stress-strain curve for the test specimen mate-

rial. Suppose that this particular specimen buckled at a stress equal to O-CrTest . As

indicated in the figure, it is assumed here that this stress lies in the inelastic region

so that NTest will be less than unity. For the purposes of this discussion, further

assume that _?Test - 0.80. If the material had remained elastic, the experimental

critical stress would have been somewhat higher than OcrTest . This greater value

will be denoted as CrcrTest . Then it follows that

(4.2-14)
°'CrTest °-CrTest
- 1.25 (rCrTest
CrcrTest - _)Test 0.80

4-14
¢rCL

(r_rTest
O'Ma x

_rcr
Test

Strain

Figure 4.2-6. Stresses Involved in Interpretation of Test Data

Now let it also be assumed that, using elastic material properties, the classical thee-

retical critical stress equals the value o-CL indicated in Figure 4.2-6. The following

formula would then give the proper value for the experimental knock-down factor:

O'CrTest 1.25 ¢rcrTe st


( ¥C)Test - (4.2-15)
¢rCL oCL
where

h 2v/t _ tz
(rCL = Ef _ _pe z {tl +t2) (4.2-16)

4-15
The abovediscussionis givenhere sincesomeof the results presentedin the literature

canbe quitemisleading. That is, comparisonsare oftenshownbetweenthe actualtest

value (rcrTest (withoutregard as to whetherelastic or not) andthe inelastic classical


theoreticalprediction. For the caseshownin Figure4.2-6, the latter valuecannot

exceed _Max andthis type of comparisonmight lead oneto believethat the appropriate
knock-downfactor is very closeto unity. However,use of the correct approachas

expressedby Equations(4.2-13)and(4.2-15)givesa muchlower Yc value. For any

given geometry, one could always show very close agreement between O'crTest and

O-Ma x simply by choosing a material with a sufficiently low yield strength and having

a flat post-yield stress-strain curve.

4-16
4.2.2 DesignEquationsandCurves

For simply supportedcircular sandwichcylinders subjectedto axial compression,the

critical stressesmaybe computedfrom the relationshipsgivenonpage4-18wherethe

subscripts1 and 2 refer to the separatefacings. "I2aere is no preference as to which

facing is denoted by either subscript. These equations were obtained by a simple ex-

tension of the formulas developed in Reference 4-7 which only considered the case

where the behavior is elastic and the moduli of elasticity are identical for both facings.

The extended versions given in this handbook were derived through the use of equivalent-

thickness concepts based on the ratios of the moduli of the two facings. For cases

where the two facings are not made of the same material, these equations are valid

only when the behavior is elastic (7 = 1). Application to inelastic cases (_? _ 1) can

only be made when both facings are made of the same material. For such configura-

tions, El and E_ will, of course, be equal.

The buckling coefficients Kc can be obtained from Figure 4.2-7. Curves are given

Gxz
there for both 0 _< i and 0 = 5 where 0 - Since these two plots are not very
Gyz

different from each other, one may use Figure 4.2-7 to obtain rather accurate esti-

mates of Kc when 1< 0 <5.

Whenever V c < 2.0, the knock-down factor Yc can be obtained from Figure 4.2-8.

When V c _> 2.0, use Yc = 1.0.

For elastic cases, use _) = 1. Whenever the behavior is inelastic, the methods of

Section 9 must be employed.

4-17
! I I I I
cq L'_

+ IJ

j
O

oJ

17 A
O

v
¢--..J

v-4
I I I I
I O,1 o,1

-.>

O
O

¢,J

+
o
¢7 L)

g-

°,.._
¢7
_>

4-18
JiJ, i¸ il
........ :!:i!

_9

0
_9

<

i
}.

1
_9

4-19
1.o _i:il
..... :::i_/_'!!I
:i!_
..... ii_i
!_....' e ...............
::i
.9 i:, x/(EI tl) (E2 t2) h

•8 'ki_ i_L[ii_4.!i_
i T i_
.............
'!t
i i,I

_'C

T:t:T!_-T, ,, jklt....
, F3 dii_t
_:ii11 i!ii

.2 : J'_' [71_i!:7
_ _ti3 : lit, " 3!7!t7['_i

I0 10 _ 10 a

Figure 4.2-8• Design Knock-Down Factor for Circular Sandwich


Cylinders Subjected to Axial Compression

4-20
The critical axial load (in units of pounds) can be computed as follows:

Pcr = 27rR [_cr_ tl + _cre t_] (4.2-26)

In the special case where t_ = t2 --- tf and both facings are made of the same material,

Equations (4.2-17) through (4.2-26) can be simplified to the following:

(rcr = Yc Kc ¢ro (4.2-27)

(_Ef) h (4.2-28)

5 2

°'crimp Gxz (4.2-29)


2 tf t c

o-o
Vc - (4.2-30)
arcrimp

Pcr = 41rRtf o-cr (4.2-31)

Equations (4.2-17) through (4.2-31) and Figure 4.2-7 are valid only when the length L

of the cylinder is greater than the length of a single axial half-wave in the buckle pat-

Gxz
tern for the corresponding infinite-length cylinder. For the case where _ - Gy z - 1,

one can apply the following test to determine if the cylinder length is sufficiently large:

When V < 2
el When Vcl > 2

Equations (4.2-17) through (4.2-31) Equations (4.2-17) through (4.2-31)

and Figure 4.2-7 are valid only where and Figure 4.2-7 are valid for any

value of L.

4-21
For constructionswhere e _ 1, nocorrespondingnumericalcriterion is presently

available. In suchcases, onecanonly usethe abovetest in conjunctionwith engineer-

ingjudgement. It is helpfulto pointout, however,thatmostpractical sandwichcylin-

ders for aerospaceapplicationswill besufficiently longfor Equations(4.2-17)through

(4.2-31) and Figure 4.2-7 to be valid. In addition, it is comforting to note that the

use of these relationships for shorter cylinders results in conservatism.

Cylinders which fail to meet the foregoing length requirement are usually referred to

as short cylinders. The only means available for the analysis of such sandwich cylin-

ders under axial compression is the solution of Stein and Mayers [4-13] which is only

valid

a. when 0 = 1

and

b. when both ends of the cylinder are simply supported

and

c. when both facings are made of the same material

and

d, the thickness of one facing is not more than twice the thickness of the

other facing.

For short sandwich cylinders which satisfy these conditions, one can use the design

curves of Figure 4.2-9 which involves the following parameters:

Z - 2L_ (4.2-32)
Rh 1-_/_e2

4-22
2
rr D
r a - (4.2-33)
L 2 Dq

• _cr (t_ + t_) Le


(4.2-34)
Kc = ycrr 2 D

where
(_ h)(E2 ts)h2
(4.2-35)
D = r](l_Pe_) [(F__tl) + (F__t_i]

h _

Dq = _-c Gxz (4.2-36)

and
L = Over-all length of cylinder, inches.

During the preparation of this handbook, no solutions were uncovered for axially com-

pressed sandwich cylinders having any degree of rotational restraint at the boundaries.

However, in most practical aerospace applications, the cylinders will be sufficiently

long for such fixity to have negligible effects on the buckling loads.

4-23
...... ]
70 ---- -_

1
4o- - + ....
•_ _
30-: _ I
I '

20-=' i

::ii4' :!
1
10_ _, :

7- --'_-, :

!
4- ..... i
K
C

• i:

.5- _ ::
.4- ,!

• 9

Figure 4.2-9. Buckling Coefficient for Short Simply-Supl_orted Sandwich Cylinders


Subjected to Axial Compression (0 :: 1)

4-24
4.3 PUIIE BEN1)ING

4.3.1 Basic Principles

4.3.1.1 Theoretical Considerations

Based on small-deflection theory, investigations were made in References 4-14, 4-15,

and 4-16 of elastic instability in thin-walled, isotropic (non-sandwich) cylinders sub-

jeeted to axial compressive stresses which vary in the circumferential direction. From

the results of these references, it can be concluded that, regardless of the nature of

the circumferential stress distribution, classical instability is reached when the peak

axial compressive stress satisfies the condition

Et
o" _.6 R (4.3-1)

It should be recalled that the value . 6 Et/R is also obtained from the small-deflection

solution for thin-walled, isotropic (non-sandwich) cylinders subjected to uniform axial

compression. In view of this result, one might reasonably expect that small-deflection

sandwich theory would also indicate that only the peak axial compressive stress need

be considered in cases of pure bending or combined bending and axial compression. It

has been shown in References 4-17, 4-18, and 4-19 that this is indeed the case. Ref-

erences 4-17 and 4-18 demonstrate this for weak-core sandwich cylinders while Ref-

erence 4-19 deals with infinitely long cylinders which fall in the stiff-core and moder-

ately-stiff-core categories. Therefore, for the purposes of this handbook, it is assumed

that the theoretical considerations of Section 4.2 (axial compression) apply equally well

to sandwich cylinders which are subjected to pure bending if the analysis considers only

the peak value of the applied compressive stress. The only differences lie in the em-

pirical knock-dow_l factors recommended for the two cases.


4-25
4.3.1.2 Empirical Knock-I)ownFactor

In the caseof pure bending, only a relatively small portion of the cylinder's circumfer-

ence experiences stress levels which initiate the buckling process. Because of the

consequent reduced probability for peak stresses to coincide with the location of an

imperfection, it is to be expected that the knock-down factors for pure bending will not

be as severe as the corresponding factors for axial load. For thin-walled, isotropic

(non-sandwich) cylinders under pure bending, Seide, et al. [4-9] have proposed the

following lower-bound relationships:

Yb = 1 - 0.731 (1 - e -¢) (4.3-2)

where

= _ (4.3-3)

Comparison against Equations (4.2-9) and (4.2-10) shows that this bending criterion

does indeed give Yb values of lesser severity than those which apply to the axially

compressed cylinders. Following the same approach as that taken in Section 4.2, the

h
above equations are rewritten in terms of the shell-wall radius of gyration p(_ for

sandwich constructions whose two facings are of equal thickness). The revised formu-

lations then give the plot shown as a dashed curve in Figure 4.3-1. Also shown in this

figure are the appropriate test points from stiff-core sandwich cylinders subjected to

pure bending [4-201. Since only three such data points are available, it was thought to

be helpful to include the axial compression sandwich data points previously shown in

Figure 4.2-3. To fully understand the information given in Figure 4.3-1, it is im-

portant for the reader to be aware of the data reduction techniques used here. For an

4-26
explanation of the procedures used in this handbook, reference should be made to the

related discussion in Section 4.2.1.2.1.

Based on the limited amount of available test data, it is recommended here that the

solid curve shown in Figure 4.3-1 be used for the design of sandwich cylinders sub-

jected to pure bending. This gives T b values that are 75 percent of those obtained

from the dashed curve which is based on the empirical formula of Seide, et al. [4-9].

This is consistent with the practice followed in Section 4.2 for the case of axial com-

pression where the design knock-down factor was likewise taken to be 75 percent of

the value obtained from the corresponding curve derived from Reference 4-9.

In view of the meager test data available from sandwich cylinders under pure bending,

the method proposed in Section 4.3.2 is not very reliable when V c < 2.0. Therefore,

in such cases, the method can only be regarded as a "best-available" approach. On

the other hand, when the failure is by shear crimping (V c >_ 2.0), the method is quite

reliable and will, in fact, usually give conservative predictions.

4-27
• !

(_) Data from Ref. 4-20 (Cylindrical; Pure Bend.)


+ Data from Ref. 4-2 (Cylindrical; Axial Compr.) t
• Data from Ref. 4-10 (Cylindrical; Axial Compr.)_

10 a
10

Figure 4.3-1. Knock-Down Factor _ for Circular Sandwich

Cylinders Subjected to Pure Bending

4-28
4.3.2 Design Equations and Curves

For simply supported sandwich cylinders subjected to pure bending, one may use the

same design equations and curves as are given in Section 4.2.2 (for axial compression)

except for the following:

a. For the ease of pure bending, use Figure 4.3.2 to obtain the knock-down

factor Yb whenever V e < 2.0 (When Vc >_2.0, use Yb = 1.0).

bo For the case of pure bending, the critical stresses obtained from the

equations and curves of Section 4.2.2 correspond to the circumferential

location which lies on the compressive side of the neutral axis and is

furthest removed from that axis. Hence the computed stresses are the

peak values within the variable circumferential distribution. Therefore,

when the behavior is elastic, the critical bending moment Mcr can be

computed from the following:

Mcr = rrR _ [¢rcr 1 t_ + _cr2 t_] (4.3-4)

where

Mcr = Critical bending moment, in.-lbs.

R = Radius to middle surface of sandwich cylinder, inches.

(rcr: and O-cra = Critical compressive stresses in facings 1 and 2, respec-

tively, which result in general instability of the cylinder, psi.

tl and ts = Thicknesses of the facings 1 and 2, respectively, inches.

Note: There is no preference as to which facing is denoted by the

subscripts 1 and 2.

4-29
1.0

.9

6
_b
5

.2

.I

I0 io_

(s)
P

Figure 4.3-2. Design Knock-Down Factor "¢b for Circular Sandwich

Cylinders Subjected to Pure Bending

4-30
To computel_cr whenthe behavioris inelastic, onemust resort to numericalintegra-
tion techniques.

Sincethe procedurerecommended
heremakesuseof the methodsof Section4.2.2, all

of the limitations of that sectionare equallyapplicableto the presentcase. Thatis,

onlysimply supportedboundariesare consideredandthe primary solutionis excess-

ively conservativefor the so--calledshort-cylinderconstructions. In addition,only

very limited meansare availableto facilitate a quantitativeassessmentof whetheror

not a particular constructionfalls within the short-cylinderclassification. Further-

more, the computationof critical stressesfor short-cylinder constructionscanonly

be accomplished
for rather specialcasesas cited in Section4.2.2.

Asnotedin Section4.2.2, duringthe preparationof this handbook,no solutionswere

uncoveredfor axially compressedsandwichcylindershavinganydegreeof rotational

restraint at the boundaries. However,it was alsonotedthat, in mostpractical aero-

spaceapplications,the cylinders will be sufficiently longfor suchfixity to havenegli-

gible effectsonthe critical stresses. The samesituationexists for the caseof pure
bending.

4-31
4.4 EXTERNAL LATERAL PRESSURE

4.4.1 Basic Principles

4.4.1.1 Theoretical Considerations

This section deals with the loading condition depicted in Figure 4.4-1. Note that the

sandwich cylinder is subjected to external pressure only over the cylindrical surface.

No axial loading is applied. In addition, it is specified that the ends are simply sup-

ported. That is, during buckling, both ends of the cylinder experience no radial dis-

placements and no bending moments.

p, psi
ends

s imply s uppo

Both rt_

p, psi

Figure 4.4-1. Circular Sandwich Cylinder Subjected to


External Lateral Pressure

The theoretical basis used here is the classical small-deflection solution of Kuenzi,

et al. [4-21] which includes the following assumptions:

a. The facings are isotropic.

b. The facings may be of equal or unequal thicknesses.

c. The facings may be of the same or different materials.

d. Poisson's ratio is the same for both facings.

e. Bending of the facings about their own middle surfaces can be neglected.

f. The core has infinite extensional stiffness m the direction normal to the

facings.

g. The core extensional and shear rigidities are negligible in directions


parallel to the facings.

4-32
h. The transverse shear properties of the core may be either isotropic or
o rthotropic.

2R
i. The inequality _- >> 1 is satisfied.

j. Several additional order-of-magnitude assumptions are valid, as noted


below in connection with Equation (4.4-2).

The solution of Kuenzi, et al. [4-21] draws upon the earlier groundwork laid by

Raville in References 4-22, 4-23, and 4-24. Norris and Zahn used these reports to

develop design curves which are published in References 4-25 and 4-26. The work of

Kuenzi, et al. [4-21] constitutes the latest revision to this series of reports and is

the most up-to-date treatment of the subject. However, the format of their results

has been slightly modified in Reference 4-5 in order to reduce the scope of interpola-

tion required in practical applications. The revised format is used here. However,

the need for interpolation has not been entirely eliminated since separate families are

still required for each of the selected values for Vp [see Equation (4.4-4)].

The final theoretical relationships used in this handbook are as follows:

Cp [(Eltl) + (E_)] (4.4-1)


Pcr = R (l-re _)

where

Cp = Minimum value (with respect to n) of Kp , dimensionless.

and
(4.4-2)

_2 (n 2 _ 1) (3 + --_--_/L\_-'_R
n2 L2 _[/n2 L22 1)(nL 7v:'R2
1+ _-)-2]+ 98 [1+ (n 2 + _]Vp]

+
4-33
(Ez tl) (E2 t_) h2
L_/2
(4.4-3)
[(Eltl) * (E_t_)laW

(Eltl) (Ezt2) h
Vp =
[(El tl) + (Ez t2)] (1;,seg)R_-Gi, z (4.4-4)

whe re

Per = Critical value of external lateral pressure, psi.

It = Radius to middle surface of cylindrical sandwich, inches.

e - Elastic Poisson's ratio of facings, dimensionless.

= Plasticity reduction factor, dimensionless.

Et and E2 = Young's modtdi of facings 1 and 2, respectively, psi.

tx and te = Thicknesses of facings 1 and 2, respectively, inches.

n
= Number of circumferential full-waves in the buckle pattern,
dimensionless.

L - Over-all length of cylinder, inches.

h - Distance between middle surfaces of facings, inches.

Gyz - Core shear modulus associated with the plane perpendicular


to the axis of revolution, psi.

Note: There is no preference as to which facing is denoted by the


subscript 1 or 2.

For cases where the two facings are not made of the same material, the foregoing

formulas are valid only when the behavior is elastic (_ = 1). Application to inelastic

cases ( E _ 1) can only be made when both facings are made of the same material.

For such configurations, E_ and E_ will, of course, be equal.

4-34
Equation(4.4-2) constitutesanapproximateexpressionfor Kp sinceit embodiesthe

assumptionscited earlier in this sectionin additionto the following:

a. Terms containingKp and 4 R2 wereneglected.

b. It wasassumedthat (1 + m2_) = 1, where m is a small whole number.

By using Equation (4.4-2), plots can be generated of the form shown in Figure 4.4-2.

The design curves of this handbook are of this type and were taken directly from Ref-

erence 4-5. It is helpful to note here that lower and upper limits exist for the coeffi-

cient Cp and these are identified in Figure 4.4-2. The lower limit is associated with

long-cylinder behavior. Such configurations are unaffected by the end constraints and

the related critical pressures are equal to those for rings which are subjected to

external pressure. For portions of the cylinders that do not lie in the neighborhoods

of the boundaries, the buckle patterns will be the same as are obtained from such rings.

In this connection, it should be noted that application of the Donnell approximations

[4-8] to non-sandwich rings leads to critical pressures which are 33 percent higher

than the predictions from accurate ring formulations. This is due to the fact that the

related number of circumferential full-waves (n = 2} is not sufficiently high to justify

Donnell's [4-8] assumptions. It is important to observe that the theory of Reference

4-21 retains a sufficient number of terms to accurately predict the buckling of long

cylinders. That is, when Gy z -* o0 {Vp -_ 0) and L/R is large, the critical pressure

is equal to the value obtained from that ring theory which is capable of properly de-

scribing the behavior where n = 2. The upper limit to the curve of Figure 4.4-2 is

associated with the shear crimping mode of failure which involves extremely short

4-35
circumferential wavelengths (n--oo). Specialization of Equations (4.4-i) through

(4.4-4) to this case gives the following formula for the critical compressive running

load Ncr measured in units of lbs/inch:

Ncr = h Gy z (4.4-5)

where

Ncr = Per It (4.4-6)

By using the approximation h _ tc , it can easily be shown that Equation (4.4-5) is

equivalent to the crimping formula presented earlier as Equation (2.3-9).

• " Crimping)

Cp

Lower Limit

(n = 2)
Note: Vp = Constant

0 a :- Constant

Figure 4.4-2. Schematic Representation of Log-Log Plot of Cp


Versus L/R for Circular Sandwich Cylinders

Subjected to External Lateral Pressure

Another important point which should be noted is that the approximate formula for Kp

[Equation (4.4-2)] does not contain the core shear modulus associated with the plane

perpendicular to the facings and oriented in the axial direction (Gxz). This modulus

has very little influence on cylinders longer than approximately one diameter and has

4-36
therefore disappeared through the approximations made in the development of Refer-

ence 4-21. Thus the theory and design curves presented in this section (Section 4.4)

of the handbook can be considered applicable to sandwich cylinders having cores with

either isotropic or orthotropic transverse shear moduli.

4-37
4.4.1.2 Empirical Knock-DownFactor

In Section4.1 it is pointedoutthat, for circular cylinderssubjectedto external

lateral pressure,the shapeol 0m post-bucklingequilibriumpathis suchthatone

wouldnot expectstrongsensitivity to the presenceof initial imlxerfections. This has

indeedbeenshownto be the casefor isotropic (non-sandwich)


cylinderswherethe

availabletestdatashowrather goodagreementwith the predictionsfrom classical

small-deflectiontheory. In viewof this, it hasbecomewidespreadpracticeto either

acceptuncorrectedsmall-deflectiontheoreticalresults asdesignvaluesor to applya

uniformknock-downfactor _p of 0.90 regardlessof the radius-to-thicknessratio.


In Reference4-4 the latter practiceis also recommended
for sandwichcylindersand

this approachhaslikewisebeenselectedas the criterion for this handbook.

Theonly availabletest datafor sandwichcylinderssubjectedto externallateral pres-

sltre are thosegivenin References4-27and 4-28. In the first of thesedocuments,

Kazimi reports the results from two specimenswhichwereidenticalexceptlor the use

of normal-expanded
core in onecylinder while the other incorporatedover-expanded

core. Thefollowingresults wereobtained:

Comparison of Theoretical Predictions Versus


Test Results of Kazimi _4-27_

@ @ @ @
Theoretical Pcr ('(P)Test

Core Type Test Pcr Based on Ref. (Test Pcr)


m

(psi) 4-5 and "/p : 1.0 (Theo. Pcr)


(psi) : ®-®
Normal-Expanded 17 30.5 .56
Over- Expanded ! 27 30.5 .88

4-38
Kazimi [4-27] attributes the scatter in his test results to the circumstance whereby

the over-expanded condition gives more uniform core properties than are obtained

from normal-expanded honeycomb. The argument put forth on behalf of this viewpoint

rests on the fact that the over-expanded core exhibits less anticlastic (saddle-type)

deformation in forming the core to the shape of the cylinder.

In Reference 4-28 Jenkinson and Kuenzi report the results obtained from five test

cylinders of nominally identical construction. These cylinders all had glass-reinforced

plastic facings. Each facing was composed of three layers of glass fabric with their

individual orientations controlled to provide a laminate having in-plane properties

which were essentially isotropic. The following results were obtained from these

cylinders :

Comparison of Theoretical Predictions Versus


Test Results of Reference 4-28

® ® ® ®
Theoretical Per (YP)Test

Cylinder Test Pcr Based on Ref. (Test Pcr)


No. (psi) 4-5 and 7p = 1.0 (Theo. Pcr)
(psi) ®+®
60 55.2 1.09
52.5 45.2 1.16
52.5 52.6 1.00
52.5 45.2 1.16
52.5 47.6 1.10

For specimens 2 through 5 it was reported that initial buckling occurred at external

lateral pressures which ranged from 50 to 55 psi. Therefore, in the above tabulation

4-39
it wasassumedthateachof thesefour cylindersbuckledat 52.5 psi. In general, the

test valuesare somewhathigherthanthe theoreticalpredictions. This is probably

due to

a. the absence of precise data on the material properties

b. inaccuracies due to interpolation between the theoretical curves


and
C. the fact that the facings were relatively thick in comparison with the

sandwich thickness (_ _ .25).

The foregoing test results from References 4-27 and 4-28 seem to provide added

justification for the use of '{1) = 0.90 as a lower-bound knock-down factor, ltowever,

it would certainly be desirable to supplement these data with additional tests on speci-

mens having small tf/h ratios which would be truly representative of configurations

usually found in realistic full-size sandwich cylinders.

An additional point of interest concerning the use of a unifornl value of Fp = 0.90 is

the fact that shear crimping failures will be insensitive to the presence of initial im-

perfections. Hence, in the region where this mode of failure prevails, one could

safely use the value ,(p = 1.0, especially since the theoretical basis used here neglects

the bending stiffnesses of the facings about their own middle surfaces. However, in-

spection of the design cuz_ves of Section 4.4.2 shows that this type of failure will only

occur for extremely low L/R values. This fact, coupled with considerations of

simplicity and the moderate nature of the value "_p - 0.90, led to the selection here

of a uniform knock-down factor.

4-40
In viewof the meagertest dataavailablefrom sandwichcylinderssubjectedto external

lateral pressure, the methodrecommended


herecanpresentlybe regardedas onlya

"best-available"approach. However,there appearsto be little reasonto doubtthat

f_'ther testingwouldshowtheseproceduresto bequitereliable.

4-41
4.4.2 DesignEquationsandCurves

For simply supportedcircular sandwichcylinderssubjectedto externallateral pres-

sure, the critical pressuremaybe computedfrom the equation

7p T, Cp
(4.4-7)
Pcr - R(l__e _) [(Eltz) _ (Eet2)]
where

"_p = 0.90

In order to use these curves,


and Cp is obtained from 1,'igures 4.4-3 through 4.4-5.

one must compute the following values:

(E _t_ )(Ea te) he


,2
(4.4-8)
uJ : [(Eltl) + (E2ta)] 2 112

(E 1 tl )(Ea ta ) h
(4.4-9)
Vp = TI [(Eltt) +(Eata)] (l-re _) He Gyz

For elastic cases, use _] = 1. Whenever the behavior is inelastic, the methods of

Section 9 must be employed.

For cases where the two facings are not made of the same material, the foregoing

formuIas are valid only when the behavior is elastic (,Z - 1). Application to inelastic

cases (_ _ 1) can only be made when both facings are made of the same material.

For such configurations, E_ and Ee will, of course, be equal.

Since separate families of design curves (Cp vs L/R) are provided for only three

values of Vp, one will usually find it necessary to use graphical interpolation or

extrapolation to establish Cp for the configuration of interest. Where desired,

4-42
improved accuracy can be obtained by minimizing Equation (4.4-2) with respect to n

in order to obtain Cp.

The results given by the procedures specified here apply to sandwich cylinders having

cores with either isotropic or orthotropic transverse shear moduli.

4-43
0.01

Yp rtC
Per '2 [(I lt]) + (E2t,2)]

I_:] - v )
\5
9O
P
\ ",v
I 2 defined by Eq. (4.,t-8)
\.

•] Vp defh]ed by Eq. (,i.4-'J)


'

CIo00] ----*,-

_x
NN N < 2
= O. 0001

N-<

/oll,-
i _-ll oJo!ol
0.000] -

C
p
......

w..:
---:oTioii
\ I

O. 00001 ---
\

X_

0.000001--.-- ---
1 10 100

Figure 4.4-3. Buckling Coefficients Cp for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


Subjected to External Lateral Pressure; Isotropic Facings;
Transverse Shear Properties of Core Isotropic or Ortho-

tropic; Vp : 0

4-44
0.0 :,.-

...... _p ,7c
2
--
..... Per - R(1 -v eP ) [(Eltl) + (E2t2)]

_2 defined by Eq. (4.4-8)

V P defined by,Eq. (4.4-9)

0.00]

O. O00l

C
P

0.00001

0,000001
10

Figure 4.4-4.
Buckling Coefficients Cp for Circular Sandwich Cylinders
Subjected to External Lateral Pressure; Isotropic Facings;
Transverse Shear Properties of Core Isotropic or Ortho-
tropic; V = 0.05
P
4-45
0.01

¢' yz 1

0.001

0.0001

C
P

0.0000]

0.000001 -- 100
1 10

Figure 4.4-5. Buckling Coefficients Cp for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


Subjected to External Lateral Pressure; Isotropic Facings;
Transverse Shear Properties of Core Isotropic or Ortho-
tropic;V = 0. i0
P
4-46
4.5 TORSION

4.5.1 BasicPrinciples

4.5. I. 1 TheoreticalConsiderations

This sectiondealswith the loadingconditiondepictedin Figure 4.5-1. Notethat the

onlyconsiderationgivento boundaryconditionsis that, during buckling, it is assumed

that no radial displacementsoccurat either end. Further conditionsat theseboundar-

ies are completelydisregarded. This approachshouldbesufficiently accuratefor all

simply supportedcylinders exceptthosewhichare very short.

T, In.-Lbs. Torque

__ T, In.-Lbs. Torque

It is assumed that, during buckling,


no radial displacements occur at
either end.

Figure 4.5-1. Circular Sandwich Cylinder Subjected to Torsion

The buckling of isotropic (non-sandwich), circular cylinders subjected to torsion was

treated by Donnell in Reference 4-8 which has become a standard source of information

concerning reasonable approximations which can be employed in practical thin-shell

theory. Using the Donnell approximations, Gerard [4-29] has investigated the buck-

ling of long circular sandwich cylinders subjected to torsion. This solution gives no

consideration whatsoever to the boundary conditions. Such an approach is valid in

4-47
view of the qssumed extremely long configuration. On the other hand, in Reference

4-30, March and Kuenzi develop small-deflection solutions for sandwich cylinders of

both finite and infinite lengths. The boundary conditions taken lot the finite-length

cylinders are as indicated in Figure 4.5-1. For the purposes of this handbook, Refer-

ence 4-30 is considered to provide the most up-to-date treatment of the subject. The

theoretical design curves given in Section 4.5.2 were taken directly from that report

and embody the following assumptions:

a. The facings are isotropic.

b. The facings are of equal thickness. However, the curves are reasonably

accurate for sandwich cylinders having unequal facings, provided that the

thickness of one facing is not more than twice the other.

c. Young's modulus is the same for both facings.

d. Poissonts ratio is the same for both facings.

e. The core has infinite extensional stiffness in the direction normal to the

facings.

f. The core extensional and shearing stiffncsses are negligible in directions

parallel to the facings.

g. The transverse shear properties of the core may be either isotropie or

o rthotropic.

h. The approximations of Donnell [4-81 can be applied.

The design curves include separate families which respectively neglect and include

bending of the facings about their own middle surfaces. However, for both of these

situations, it is assumed that the facings are thin.

4-48
The theoreticalbucklingrelationshipusedhereis

d
rcr = K s ]] ErR (4.5-1)

which is based on the further assumption that both facings are made of the same mate-

rial. The notation used here is as follows:

rcr = Critical value of facing shear stress, psi.

Ks : Torsional buckling coefficient, dimensionless.

= Plasticity reduction factor, dimensionless.

Ef - Young's modulus of facings, psi.

d = Total thickness of sandwich wall.

d t c +tz + te (4.5-2)

t c = Thickness of core, inches.

t l and te : Thicknesses of the facings (There is no preference as to which facing


is denoted by the subscript 1 or 2.), inches.

R - Radius to middle surface of sandwich cylinder, inches.

The buckling coefficient Ks is arrived at by the minimization of a complicated ex-

pression given in Reference 4-30. This formulation is not reproduced here. However,

it should be noted that the indicated minimization leads to Ks values which can be

plotted in the general form shown in Figure 4.5-2 where

L_
Zs - dR (4.5-3)

16 t c tlt_ Ef
- (4.5-4)
Vs 15 (tl +t2) Rd Gxz

4-49
Gxz
(4.5-5)
Gyz

and
L - Over-all length of cylinder, inches.

Gxz = Core shear modulus associated with the plane perpendicular to the

facings and oriented m the axial direction, psi.

Gy z = Core shear modulus associated with the plane perpendicular to the

axis of revolution, psi.

n Number of circumferential full-waves in the buckle pattern,

d imens ionl es s.

t c/d - Constant I
_ Constant '/
K s
Upper Limit (Shear Crimping)
: Constant ]
Long Cylinder
(,1 : 2)

ZS

Figure 4.5-2. Typical Log-Log Plot of the Buckling Coefficient K_


for Circular Sandwich Cylinders Subjected to Torsion

The curves given in Section 4.5.2 are of this type. Note that the upper limit for the

buckling coefficient K s correspends to the shear crimping mode of failure which

involves extremely short circumferential wave-lengths (n -. _o). Specialization of

the buckling equations to this case leads to the following result when it is assumed

that tc/d _ I :

4-50
5 2

Tcr = rcrimp - (tz + t_) tc v/Gxz GY z (4.5-6)

where

h =
Distance between middle surfaces of facings, inches.

In connection with sandwich constructions having large values for the parameter Zs

(long cylinders), it is pointed out that the cylinder will buckle into an oval shape (n = 2)

for which the Donnell approximations [4-8] are no longer valid. To illustrate this

point, attention is drawn to the results obtained for isotropic (non-sandwich), circular

cylinders subjected to torsion. By using the Donnell approximations, Gerard [4-31]

obtains the following result for the critical shear stress of such cylinders:

rcr - (l_Ve_)a/_ E (4.5-7)

In Reference 4-32, Timoshenko presents the following result from a more rigorous

solution which does not invoke the Donnell approximations:

: E (.___.) 3/_
rcr 3 _]2 (1-Ve2)a/a (4.5-8)

The more exact result gives a critical stress which is only 87 percent of that given by

the Donnekl approach, This is similar to the situation encountered in the case of exter-

nal lateral pressure (see Section 4.4) where the difference is even more pronounced.

Since the torsional design curves of Section 4.5.2 incorporate the Donnell approxima-

tions, they must be used with caution in the case of long cylinders (n = 2).

4-51
4.5.1.2 Empirical Knock-Down Factor

In Section 4.1 it is pointed out that, for circtdar cylinders subjected to torsion, the

shape of tile post-buckling equilibrium path is such that one would not expect the sensi-

tivity to initial imperfections to be as strong as that encountered in tile case of axial

compression. On the other h:md, tile sensitivity iil torsion would be expected to be

somewhat more severe than is exhibited by circular cylinders under external lateral

pressure, hi the case of isotropic (non-sandwich), circtdar cylinders loaded in torsion

I{eference 4-8 indicates that, over an enormous range of sizes, proportions, and

materials, a lower-bound curve to the available test data can be obtained by taking

60 percent of the values obtained from classical small-deflection theory {_ - 0.60).

Average values of the test data can be approximated by using 80 percent of the classi-

cal theoretical predictions (3's = 0.80)

To date, no test data has been ptd)lished for sandwich cylinders which are of the types

consider_t in this hmld!yook and are subjected to torsion. Therefore, no empirical

basis exists lor the determination of reliable knock-down lactors in such cases.

Based on the moderate drop-off of the post-buclding equilibrium path, some sources

[4-51 recommend that no reduction be employed ( "_s :: 1.0). ttowever, Reference 4-4

takes a more cautious approach in recommending the use of _s .80 for the sand-

wich configuration. This selection was made largely on the basis of the isotropic

(non-sandwich) data. Although this value did not furnish a lower-bound to the isotropic

test points, it is reasonable to expect that the usually greater thicknesses of sandwich

cylinders should lead to more moderate reductions than apply to the isotropic (non-

4-52
sandwich) conligurations. In addition, it should be noted that cylinders under torsion

will continue to supt_)rt considerable torque well into the postbuckled region, ttence

the torsional buckling mechanism should not be nearly so catastropic as the general

instability of axially compressed cylinders. With these several factors in mind, the

value "is - O. 80 has been selected for use in this handbook. In view of the lack of

sandwich test data to substantiate this selection, the methods proposed here can only

be regarded as a "best-available" approach.

4-53
4.5.2 Design Equations and Curves

For simply supported circular sandwich cylinders subjected to torsion, the critical

shear stress may be computed from the equation

d
rcr = Xs Ks _ Ef _ (4.5-9)

where

"¢s = 0.80 (4.5-10)

d = tc + t_ + t_ (4.5-11)

and Ks is obtained from Figures 4.5-3 through 4.5-8. border to use these cu_,es,

one must first compute each of the following values:

L2
Zs - (4.5-12)
dR

V = 16 tc t_ t_ TiEr (4.5-13)
s 15 (tl + t_) R d Gxz

Gxz
@ - (4.5-14)
Gyz

It is required here that both facings be made of the same material.

For elastic cases, use r1 = 1. Whenever the behavior is inelastic, the methods of

Section 9 must be employed.

The critical torque Tcr , measured in units of in.-lbs, can be computed from the

following for both elastic and inelastic cases:

Tcr = 2rrR 2 (tl + ts) rcr (4.5-15)

4 -54
Culwesfor Ks aregiven for values of @ -0.4; 1.0; and 2.5. Estimates of Ks

for other values of @ can be obtained by interpolation.

In addition, curves for Ks are given for values of t c/d = 1.0 and 0.7. The former

neglect the contribution from bending of the facings about their own middle surfaces.

The latter may be used to obtain numerical estimates of the conservatism introduced

by neglecting these stiffnesses.

As noted in Section 4.5.1.1, the design curves are somewhat inaccurate in the region

where Zs is large (long cylinders). Some caution should be exercised in the appli-

cation of the curves in this region.

Strictly speaking, Figures 4.5-3 through 4.5-8 apply only when the facings are equal.

However, the curves are reasonably accurate for sandwich cylinders having unequal

facings, provided that the thickness of one facing is not more than twice the other.

4-55
e_

r_

.!
m

El

4-56
0

¢)

II II

_J

¢)

0
C)

iZ/

4-57
0

b
or,,i

°,,-I
r..)

II

4-58
S

E)

4-59
.2

_D

"0

.2

e_

.2

I
t_

O(3
o
S

4-60
©

,.,,-.i

%
©

ca

od
I

4-61
4.6 TRANSVERSE SI[EAR

4.6.1 Basic Principles

In Reference 4-33, Lundquist reports the results from a series of tests on isotropic

(non-sandwich), circular cylinders subjected to combined transverse shear and bend-

ing. The same type of data is published in Reference ,I-34 for elliptical cylinders.

Both sets of data were obtained from cantilevered cylinders of varied lengths. Extrapo-

lation of these results to the condition of zero bending stress permits a determination

of critical stresses for pure transversc shear loading. It has proven useful to com-

pare these stress values against the theoretical results obtained from small-deflection

theory for isotropic (non-sand_vich), circular cylinder,_ loaded in torsion. Gerard and

Becker [4-35j report that, for nominally identical specimens, such comparisons yield

the following ratios where the theoretical predictions are obtained by using Reference

4-36:

Average of "rer
Shear Test Values f¢)r t
Transverse Loading
Small-Deflection Theoretical Ter
[ Values for Torsional Loading i a, 1.(; (4.6-1)

Lower-BoundTcr Shear Test Values for]


Transverse Loading
_ 1.25 (4.6-2)
Small-Deflection Theoretical Vc r ]
Values for Torsional Loading j

To properly interpret these ratios, it is pointed out that, for torsional loading, the

shear stress Tcr is uniformly distributed around the circumference. On the other

hand, under transverse shear loading, the shear stress is non-uniform and the value

Tcr then corresponds to the peak intensity which occurs at the neutral axis.

4-62
For the lack of a better approach,it is recommonded
that Equation(4._;-2)beused[or

the designandanalysisof circular sandwichcylindersthat are subjectedto transverse

shearforces. In suchcases,the requiredsmall-deflectiontheoreticalrcr valuesfor

torsional loadingshouldbeobtainedas specifiedin Section4.5 of this handbook


with

the exceptionthat 7s = 1.0 shouldbeusedhere. Notest dataare availableto sub-

stantiatethe reliability of this practice. Until suchdatadobecomeavailable, onecan

onlyregardthis procedureas a "best-available"approach.

4-63
4.6.2 DesignEquationsandCurves

For simply supportedcircular sandwichcylinderssubjectedto a transverseshear

force andhavingboth facingsmadeofthe samematerial, the critical shearstress

maybe computedfrom the equation


d
rcr = 1.25KsrlEf -_ (4.6-3)

where thebucklingcoefficientKs is obtainedfrom Figures4.5-3 through4.5-8 and

the notationis the sameas thatemployedthroughoutSeetion4.5. As notedin Section

4.5.1.1, thesefigures are somewhatinaccuratein the regionwhere Zs is large (long

cylinders)andoneshouldexercisesomecautionwhendealingwith suchconfigurations.

Strictly speaking,Figures4.5-3 through4.5-8 applyonlywhenthe facingsare of equal

thickness. Itowever,the curvesare reasonablyaccuratefor san_viehcylinders having

unequalfacings,providedthatthe thicknessof onefacingis not more thantwice the

other.

For elastic eases,use r? = 1. Whenever the behavi'n" is inelastic, the methods of

Section 9 must be employed.

For elastic eylinders the critical transverse shear force (Fv)cr, measured in units of

pounds, can be computed from the following:

(Fv)er = rrR (t 1 + ta) rer (4.6-4)

To compute (Fv)cr when the behavior is inelastic, one must resort to numerical inte-

gration techniques.

4-64
4.7 COMBINED
LOADINGCONDITIONS

4.7.1 General

For structural memberssubjectedto combinedloads, it is customary to represent

critical loading conditions by means of so-called interaction curves. Figure 4.7-1

shows the graphic format usually used for this purpose. The quantity R. is the ratio
1

of an applied load or stress to the critical value for that type of loading when acting

alone. The quantity R. is similarly defined for a second type of loading. Curves of
J

this form give a very clear picture as to the structural integrity of particular con-

figurations. All computed points which fall within the area bounded by the interaction

curve and the coordinate axes correspond to stable structures. All points lying on or

outside of the interaction curve indicate that buckling will occur. Furthermore, as

shown in Figure 4.7-1, a measure of the margin of safety is given by the ratio of

distances from the actual loading point to the curve and to the origin. For example,

assume that a particular structure is subjected to the combined loading condition

corresponding to point B of Figure 4.7-1.

Then, for proportional increases in R. and R., the margin of safety (M.S.) can be
1 j

computed from the following:

(Rj)D
M.S. - 1 (4.7-I)
(Rj)B

As an alternative procedure, one might choose to compute a minimum margin of safety

which is based on the assumption that loading beyond point B follows the path BM.

Point M is located in such a position that BM is the shortest line that can be drawn

4-65
between point B and the interaction curve. The minimum margin of safety can then be

calculated as follows:

OB _ BM
Minimum M.S. OB 1 (4.7-2)

1.0

(Rj) D _M

(Rj)B

R
J

iiiiii

0 R 1.0
i

Figure 4.7-1. Smnple Interaction Curve

4-66
4.7.2 Axial Compression Plus Bending

i.7.2.1 Basic Principles

In References 4-17, 4-18, and 4-19 it has been shown that, for circular sandwich

cylinders subjected to axial compression plus bending, the classical theoretical

interaction curve may be accurately described by the equation

(4.7-3)
(Re)c L + (Rb) C L = 1
where

U
e
(4.7-4)
(Rc)cL -
(5c)CZ

_b
(.i. 7-_)
{Rb)cL- (Sb)CL

= (4. v-6)
((_b) CL ((_e) C L

and

(Y = Uniform compressive stress due solely to applied axial load,


e
psi.

= Peak compressive stress due solely to applied bending mo-


_b
ment, psi.

= Classical theoretical value for critical uniform compressive


(_c)CL
stress under an axial load acting alone, psi.

= Classical theoretical value for critical peak compressive


((_b) C L
stress under a bending moment acting alone, psi.

References 4-17 and 4-18 develop the foregoing result for weak-core constructions

which fail in the shear crimping mode. On the other hand, Reference 4-19 deals

with infinitely long cylinders which fall in the stiff-core and the moderately-stiff-

core categories. Since Equation (4.7-3) is written in terms of classical theoretical

4-f;7
allowables,it doesnot includeanyconsiderationof the detrimentalinfluencesfrom

initial imperfections. For the pullmsesof this handbook,theseinfluencesare treated

by'introducingtheknock-dt_vnfactors ye and Tb (see Figures 4.2-8 and 4.3-2, re-

spectively) to obtain

Rc +Rb = 1 (4.7-7)
where

e
R - (4.7-8)
c 'Yc ((_c) C L

(_b

% Yb ((_c) CL (4.7-9)

Therefore, the design interaction curve can be drawn as shown in Figure 4.7-2. Since

no test data is available for sandwich cylinders subjected to combined axial load and

bending, the general validity of this curve has not been experimentally verified. Some

degree of empirical correlation is inherent in the approach since the knock-down fae-

tors 3/c and 7b were established, in part, from sandwich test data (see Sections 4.2

and 4.3). ttc_vever, even these data were few in number. Therefore, until further

experimental substantiation is obtained, the recommended interaction relationship

can only be considered a "best-available" method.

lo0 -

Rc 1.0

Figure 4.7-2. Design Interaction Curve for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


Subjected to Axial Compression Plus Bending
4-68
4.7.2.2 Design Equations and Curves

For simply suppol_ed, circular, sand_vich cylinders subjected to axial compression

plus bending, the following interaction equation may be employed:

Re + Rb = 1 (4.7-10)

w h e re

(y
c
R - (4.7-11)
c Tc ((7c) C L

au - _b (_c)CL
(4.7-12)

A plot of Equation (4.7-10) is given in Figure 4.7-3.

In Equations (4.7-11) and (4.7-12), the knock-down factors Tc and _b are those ob-

tained from Figures 4.2-8 and 4.3-2, respectively.

The quantity (ffc)CL is simply the result obtained by using Tc = 1.0 in the method of

Section 4.2.2.

Plasticity considerations should be handled as specified in Section 9.2 except that,

in this case, one may use

ao
IlVel Et
r7 = [ 1---2-_1 _ff for short cylinders, and

t s
b. _ --
for moderate-length through long cylinders.
tl-u_] Ef

Equation (4.7-10) may be applied to sandwich cylinders of any length. However, length

considerations should be included in the computation of ((_c)CL when the structure falls

into the short-cylinder range (see Section 4.2.2).

4-69
0.8

!i!ii
0.6 _' j

i!il
Rb

0 0. '2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0


R
C

Figure 4.7-3. I)esigm Interaction Curve for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


Subjected to Axial Compression Plus tk, nding

4-70
4.7.3 Axial Compression Plus External Lateral Pressure

4.7. :5.1 Basic Principles

This section deals with the loading condition depicted in Figure 4.7-4. The sandwich

cylinder is subjected to uniform external pressure over the cylindrical surface. Axial

loading is imposed as indicated by the [orces P. These forces can originate from any

source including external pressures which are uniformly distributed over the end elos-

ures. In addition, it is specified that the ends of the eylinder are simply supported.

This is, during buckling, the ends are constrained such that they experience no radial

or circumferential displacements and they are free of bending moments.


p , psi
Y
p , psi
Y I

lbs
P, lbs__

/ lllttIlIIlt'(
Both Ends Simply Supported

Figure 4.7--4. Circular Sandwich Cylinder Subjected to Axial


Compression Plus External Lateral Pressure

The theoretical basis used here is the classical small--deflection solution of Maki

[4-37]. The design curves given in this handbook were taken directly from that source

and embody the following assumptions:

ao The facings are isotropic.

b. Both facings are of the same thickness.

e. Both facings have identical material properties.

4-71
d.
Poisson's ratio for the facings is equal to 0.33.

e° Bending of the facings about their own middle surfaces can be neglected.

f. The core has infinite extensional stiffness in the direction normal to the
facings.

g* The core extensional and shear rigidities arc negligible in directions


parallel to the facings.

ho The transverse shear moduli of the core are the same in the circum-
ferential and longitudinal directions (G = G ).
xz yz

io
The mean radius of the cylinder is large in comparison with the sandwich
thickness.

The theoretical relationship derived by Maki [4-37_ is in the form of a complicated

sixth order determinant and no significant advantage would be gained by reproducing

that formulation in this handbook. However, it is important to note that a sufficient

number of terms were retained throughout the derivation to obtain accurate results

when the number of circumferential full-waves equals two (n = 2). If the derivation

had been based on the well-known Donnell approximations [4-81, the results would

not be applicable to structures which buckle in this manner.

The interaction curves given in Reference 4-37 are of the two different types depicted

in Figure 4.7-5 where

Ef tf h
V - (4.7-13)
xz 2 (1-.33e) RaG
XZ

Eftfh
Vyz = 2 (1- (4.7-14)
.33_) RaG
yz

P
_ Y
(4.7-15)
(Rp) CL _y) CL

4-72
cr
x

(Rc)CL (4.7-16)
(C_x)C L

and

Ef : Young's modulus of facings, psi.

tf = Thickness of single facing, inches.

h = I)istancc between middle surfaces of facings, inches.

R = Radius to middle surface of cylindrical sandwich, inches.

G = Core shear modulus associated with the plane perpendicular


XZ
to the facings and oriented in the axial direction, psi.

G = Core shear modulus associated with the plane perpendicular


yz
to the axis of revolution, psi.

p = Applied external lateral pressure, psi.


Y

(1-iy)CL = Classical theoretical value for critical external lateral pressure


when acting alone, psi.

g = Uniform axial compressive stress due to applied axial load, psi.


X

(C_x)C L = Classical theoretical value for critical tmiform axial compres-


sive stress when acting alone, psi.

L = Over-all length of cylinder, inches.

Note : The value .33 appearing in Equations (4.7-13) and (4.7-14) is an


assumed representative value for the elastic Poissonts ratio of
the facings.

Since the curves of Reference 4-37 were developed from a classical, small-deflection

approach, they do not include any consideration of the detrimental effects from initial

imperfections. This is evident from the fact that classical theoretical allowables are

used in the ratios (Rp)cL and (Rc)CL. For the purposes of this handbook, the effects

4-73
1.0 1.0 : 4> -._I

% ..
o
(Rc)CL
(Rc)CL
Jill/ = Constant \

\XZ - \VZ - O/ _

[-_ : Constant] _ .

1.0 1.0
(tlp)CL (Rp)CL

Figure 4.7-5. Typical Interaction Curves for Circular Sanchvieh Cylinders Subjected
to Axial Compression Plus External Lateral Pressure

from initial imperfections are introduced through the replacement of (%)CL and

and R which are defined as follows:


(Re)CL by the ratios Rp c

Py
R = - (4.7-17)

P Tp (Py) CL

(y
R = x (4.7-18)
e Yc ((_x) C L

The quantities yp and Yc are the knock-down factors discussed in Sections 4.4 and 4.2,

respectively. Values for yc can be obtained from Figure 4.2-8 while yp may be taken

equal to 0.90.

No test data are available for sandwich cylinders which are of the types considered

here and are subjected to axial compression plus external lateral .ressure. Therefore,

the general validity of the design curves recommended here has not been experimentally

verified. Some degree o[ empirical correlation is inherent in the approach since the

4-74
knock-down factors Te and Tp were established, in part, from sandwich test data (see

Sections 4.2 and 4.4). ttowever, even these data were few in nmnber. Therefore,

until further eN)erimental substantiation is obtained, the recommended interaction

curves can only be considered as "best-available" criteria.

4-75
4.7.3.2 DesignEquationsandCurves

For simply supported,circular, sandwichcylinderssubjectedto axial compression

plus externallateral pressure, onemayemploythe interactioncurvesof Figures

4.7-6 through4.7-15where
Eftf h
(4.7-19)
xz 2(1-. 33z')R_ Gxz

Eftf h
(4.7-20)
Vyz 2(1-.332)R _G
yz

P
Y (4.7-21)
R =
P Yp (Py)CL

R = x (4.7-22)
c Tc (fix) C L

In Equations (4.7-21) and (4.7-22), the knock-down factor Tc is that obtained from

Figure 4.2-8 while Tp may be taken equal to 0.90.

The quantity (15y)CL is simply the result obtained by using 7p = 1.0 in the methods of

Section 4.4.

The quantity ((_x)CL is simply the result obtained by using Tc = 1.0 in the methods of

Section 4.2.

Plasticity considerations should be handled as specified in Section 9.2.

Figures 4.7-6 through 4.7-12 give interaction curves only for cases where Vxz =

V = 0 (G = G - co). Separate families are provided for each of three selected


yz xz yz

values for the parameter -_ = 50; 160 and 500 . Graphical interpolation may be

4-76
used to obtain results for intermediate values of this parameter. Each family includes

separate curves for ten different values of the ratio --L-- -- = 0.1; 0.'2; --- 1. . In

view of the restrietions on V and V , these curves can only be used to describe the
xz yz

behavior of stiff-core eonstruetions. For the purposes of praetieal design and analysis,

it is proposed here that Figures 4.7-6 through 4.7-12 be considered applicable only

when

Rt
C
-- V ± 0.05 (4.7-23)
h_ xz

Rt
C
V _ 0.05 (4.7-24)
h* yz

\vhcre

t = Thickness of core, inches.


C

It is ex_pected that many realistic sandwich configurations will satisfy these requirements.

Fi_ires 4.7-13 through 4.7-15 present a partial picture of the effects which variations

in V (= V ) will have on the interaction relationships. These figures only treat


XZ yZ

cases for which --rrR _= 0.1. }tc_vever, the trends displayed furnish some basis for one
I,

to conjecture that the curves given for V = V = 0 would result in conservative pre-
xz yz

dictions if they were applied to sandwich configurations which do not satisfy the In-

equalities (4.7-23) and (4.7-24). However, one should be cautioned againstmaking

sweeping application of this observation in view of the limited scope of the information

shown in Figures 4.7-13 through 4.7-15.

4-77
It shouldbe kept in mindthatthe interactioncurvesgivenin Figures4.7-6 through

4.7-12 include C L values ranging only from 0.1 through 1.0. Since

_R
C - (4.7-25)
L L

it follows that these curves only embrace the range where

L
3.14 _ -_- <- 31.4 (4.7-2(;)

4-78
h= 50

O.
8 _. Vxz = Vyz : 0,0

__C rrI1

0.6

O. ,1

0,2

0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0°8 1,0


R
P

Figure 4.7-6. Interaction Curves for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


Subjected to Axial Compression Plus External
Lateral Pressure

4-79
1
I1
50
11

V = V = 0.0
xz yz

'gR
C
I_ L

0.6

R
C

0.4

CL 0.7"

CL 0.8-
C O. 9_
0.2

0
0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0
R
P

Figure 4.7-7. Interaction Curves for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


Subjected to Axial Compression Plus External
I,ateral Pressure

4-80
1.0
R
N = 50
h

V = V = 0.0
0.8 xz yz

_R
C =
L L

0,6
'0
R
c
\
0.4

0.2

0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0


R
P

Figure 4.7-8. Interaction Curve for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


Subjected to Axial Compression Plus External
Lateral Pressure

4-81
I
H
-- 160
h

V :-: V :: 0.0
- xz yz --

=0.]

0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0


R
P

Figure 4.7-9. Interaction Curves for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


Subjected to Axial Compression Plus External
Lateral Pressure

4-82
I
R
-- 160
h

0.8 = V 0.0

C LC_ 0_ 8(_ KC L = 0.6 Vxz ?rRYZ


) CL _[[
0.6 _ I

0.4 C
L

0.2

0
0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0
R
P

Figure 4.7-10. Interaction Curves for Circular Sandwich


Cylinders Subjected to Axial Compression
Plus External Lateral Pressure

4-83
1.0 I
R
CLI0. 4 5O0
h

_ jt/ICL = 0. V = V = 0.0
0.8 xz yz -

_R
C
C L = 0.5'__ L L

0.6

R
c

0.4

C L = 0.3
C =0.1
L

0.2

0
0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0
R
P

Figure 4.7-11. Interaction Curves for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


Subjected to Axial Compression Plus External
Lateral Pressure

4-84
= 0o0

R
C

0.4
=0.8
CL=0.

0.2

0
0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0
R
P

Figure 4.7-12. Interaction Curves for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


Subjected to Axial Compression Plus External
Lateral Pressure

4-85
l°01

R
C

R
P

Figure 4.7-13. Interaction Curves for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


Subjected to Axial Compression Plus External
Lateral Pressure

4-86
R
C

0.2

0
o 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0
R
P

Figure 4.7-14. Interaction Curves for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


Subjected to Axial Compression Plus External
Lateral Pressure

4-87
1.0

0.8

t 5

0.6 % kk --

R %
C

0.4 \
h = 500

0.2 --

CL = _R
I--_- =0.1

0 0.2 0.4 0,6 0.8 1.0


R
P

Figure 4.7-15. Interaction Curves for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


Subjected to Axial Compression Plus External
Lateral Pressure

4-88
4.7.4 Axial CompressionPlus Torsion

4.7.4.1 BasicPrinciples

This sectiondealswith the loadingconditiondepictedin Figure4.7-1(;. Thesanchvich

cylinder is subjectedto endtorqueT plus axial loadingindicatedby the forces P.

T, in-lbs Torque T, in-lbs Torque

BothEnds
SimplySupported

Figure 4.7-16. Circular Sandwich Cylinder Subjected to


Axial Compression Plus Torsion

In Reference 4-18 Wang, et al. treat this type of problem but only consider the case

of weak-core configurations which fail in the shear crimping mode. In addition they

assume that the cylinder is long so that the boundary conditions can be ignored. This

small-deflection analysis makes use of the Donnell approximations [4-8] to arrive at

the following interaction relationship:

(4.7-2 7)
(Rc)CL + (Rs) CL
2 = 1
where

C
(4.7-28)
(Rc)CL - _
(_c)CL

4-89
I- (4.7-29)
(Rs)CL- (_)CL

and

(I = Uniform axial compressive stress due to applied axial load, psi.


c

= Classical theoretical value for crilical uniform axial eompres-


((_e)CL
sire stress when acting alone, psi.

_- = Uniform shear stress due to applied torque, psi.

(T)CL = Classical theoretical value for critical uniform shear stress


duc to torque acting alone, psi.

Because Equation (4.7-27) was developed from a classical, small-deflection approach,

it does not include any consideration of the detrimental effects from initial imperfee-

tions. That is evident from the fact that classical theoretical allc_vables are used in

the ratios (Rc)cL and (Rs)CL. For the purposes of this handbook, the effects from

initial imperfections are introduced through the replacement of (Rc)cL and (Rs)CL by

the ratios R and 1R which are defined as follows:


c s

(y
c
R -
(4.7-30)
c "/c(ffc)C L

R _ 1- (4.7-31)
s
7s (_)CL

The quantities _c and _s are the knock-down factors discussed in Sections 4.2 and 4.5,

respectively. Values for Yc can be obtained from Figure 4.2-8 while :Ys may be taken

equal to 0.80. Incorporation of the foregoing substitutions into Equation (4.7-27) then

gives the following interaction relationship for weak-core constructions:

R + R 2 = 1 (4.7-32)
c s

4-90
In Reference 4-38, Batdorf, et el. deal with the subject loading condition for thin-

walled, isotropic (non-smldwich), circular cylinders. Since, for such constructions,

transverse shear deformations of the shell wall are of negligible importance, one

might conjecture thai this work could be applied to sandwich cylinders which fall into

the stiff-core category. Based on theoretical considerations modified by test results,

Batdorf, et el. c4-38n: arrived at the same interaction expression as that given above

as Equation (4.7-32). In view of this, one might choose to view Equation (4.7-32) as

a comprehensive interaction formula for sandwich cylinders, ttowever, some caution

should be observed in implementing this viewpoint, partially because of the fact that

only the extremes of transverse shear stiffness of the core have been considered. In

addition, although the interaction relationship for the subject loading condition should

probably be dependent upon a length parameter, no investigations were made to estab-

lish the sandwich cylinder lengths over which Equation (4.7-32) is a reasonable repre-

sentation of the actual behavior. Furthermore, no test data are available for sandwich

cylinders which are of the types considered in this handbook and are subjected to axial

compression plus torsion. Therefore the general validity of Equation (4.7-32) has not

been experimentally verified. Some degree of empirical correlation is inherent in the

approach since the knock-down factor _'e was established, in part, from sandwich test

data (see Section 4.2). ttowever, even these data were few in number. Therefore,

until further theoretical and experimental investigations are accomplished, the inter-

action relationship cited here can only be considered as a "best-available" criterion.

4-91
4.7.4.2 Design Equations and Curves

For simply supported, circular, sandwich cylinders subjected to axial compression

plus torsion, one might choose to employ the interaction formula

R +R _ = 1 (4.7-33)
c s

which is plotted in Figure 4.7-17 and where

a
R - c (4.7-34)
c _'c (_c) CL

R - _" (4.7-35)
s
Ys (_) C L

In Equations (4.7-34) and (4.7-35), the knock-down factor _c is that obtained from

Figure 4.2-8 while _s may be taken equal to 0.80.

The quantity ((_c)CL is simply the result obtained by using )'c = 1.0 in the methods of

Section 4.2.

The quantity (_) is simply the result obtained by using _s = 1.0 in the methods of
CL

Section 4.5.

Plasticity considerations should be handled as specified in Section 9.2.

Attention is drawn to the fact that, in Section 4.7.4.1, several factors are cited which

shed considerable doubt upon the reliability of results obtained from the indiscriminate

use of Equation (4.7-33) and Figure 4.7-17. In view of these uncertainties, one might

often choose to employ the straight-line interaction formula

R + R = 1 (4.7-36)
c s

4-92
which is plotted in Figure 4.7-18. This relationship can be used with confidence for

any length of cylinder and for any region of transverse shear rigidity of the core since

experience has shown that the linear interaction formula is never unconservative for

shell stability problems, ttowever, in many cases it will, of course, introduce execs-

sive conservatism.

(}. (!

CO 0.2 0.4 0. (; 0. _ I . 0

Figure 4.7-17. Conditional Interaction Curve for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


Subjected to Axial Compression Plus Torsion
4-93
0.6

R
s

0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0


R
c

Figure 4.7-18. Conservative Interaction Curve for Circular Sandwich Cylinders


Subjected to Axial Compression Plus Torsion

4-94
4.7.5 Other Loading Combinations

4.7.5.1 Basic Principles

In Sections 4.7.3 and 4.7.4 the following combined loading conditions are treated:

a. Axial Compression plus External Lateral Pressure.

b. Axial Compression plus Torsion.

The corresponding interaction relationships can be used for certain additional com-

binations by recognizing that

a. the peak axial stress due to an applied bending moment can be converted

inio an equivalent uniform a.xial stress, and

b. the peak shear stress due to a transverse shear force can be converted

into an equivalent tmiform torsional shear stress.

With this in mind, the design equations and curves of Section 4.7.3.2 can be used for

the combination o[ AXIAL COMPRESSION PLUS BENDLNG PLUS EXTERNAL LATERAL

PRESSURE if one simply substitutes the quantity g_ for (_ whe re


X X

, = ((:rx)c +()'c_ ((rx)b (4.7-37)


% \rb/

and

= Uniform axial compressive stress due solely to applied axial


((_X) C
load, psi.

= Peak axial compressive stress due solely to applied bending


(Crx) b
moment, psi.

= Knock-down factor associated with axial compression and as


%
given in Figure 4.2-8, dimensionless.

= Knock-down [actor associated with pure bending and as given in


_zb
Figure 4. ;/-2, dimensionless.

4-95
This formula is based on the findings reported in Section 4.3.

In addition, the design equations and curves of Section 4.7.4.2 can be used for the

combination of AXIAL COMPRESSION PLUS BENDING PLUS TORSION PLUS TRANS-

VERSE SHEAR FORCE if one simply substitutes the quantities _' and T _ for (_ and 1",
C C

respectively, where

(4.7-38)
(r'e = (_c)c + (_c)b

, O. 80
T = T T + 1.2----55rV = 7"T + 0"641"V (4.7-39)

and

(gc) c = Uniform axial compressive stress due solely to applied axial


load, psi.

(gc) b = Peak axial compressive stress due solely to applied bending


moment, psi.

_'T = Uniform shear stress due solely to applied torque, psi.

TV = Peak shear stress due solely to applied transverse shear force,


psi.

7c and :_b = Knock-down factors specified above.

Equation (4.7-38) is based on the findings reported in Section 4.3 while Equation

(4.7-39) stems from a comparison of Equations (4.5-9) and (4.6-3).

Since no sandwich test data are available to substantiate the foregoing procedures, they

can only be regarded as "best-available" criteria.

4-9G
4.7.5.2 DesignEquationsandCmwes

For the combinationof AXIAL COMPRESSION


PLUSBENDINGPLUSEXTERNAL

LATERALPRESSURE,
substitute(_X for(_X andusethe designequationsandcurves
follows:
given in Section 4.7.3.2. The quantity (i X is defined as

(4.7-4O)
0"X = (ax) c + ((Ix) b

used in Section 4.7.3.2 remains as defined in thai


Itowever, the quantity (CTx)CL

sectior_.

For the combination of AXIAL COMPRESSION PLUS BENDING PLUS TORSION PLUS

TRANSVERSE SIIEAR FORCE, substitute cr I for a and T _ for "r in the design equations
e c

and curves given in Section 4.7.4.2. The quantities a t and _-_ are defined as follows:
e

e = (<:'c)e\ 'bl
u (4.7-41)

0.80
7" = T T + 1.2-----_o
"rV = TT + 0.64"r V (4.7-42)

However, the quantities ((Tc)CL and (_)CL used in Section 4.7.4.2 remain as defined

in that section.

The foregoing criteria will still apply, of course, where one or more of the specified

applied loads equal zero.

4-97
^ o

I . t
ao
i

.# ul

1
,--t

_t_ _ _ O H
_ m

"tJ

o
.o
L_
o b
"8
e_

•_ ,, ,, o_ -_ _ o

__ -_ .
N

"o Ii N
% L) ° el# °
r_

r_
,2 d d
c,1 _,1 > 2®_ o
..... _ "_'_K_ V AI II e_ o o.
_2
d ° d'
II > > & 0
% b b > o _1 o

II % "_

_._o _, _ o
e_
._
o
N O [._ II
_ "_,_ _ _o o

Q q_ _ o

(_ "_ _ 0
NI.._

h vl

£zJi
o
,-1
o _.-i I
o_ °"K v _ _ _.
z

4-98
©

<
o
_q

t_

O)

@ "a o
8

o .,2.If

o
,x2,
e_ I

d'

rll o © c,,! ,.g


v_

r-,
If _,

.P
o
o
_,o II I1
H

o_.oK

dz o _D

H
V H _
"_o_,_.
H

°_

K
×V uoTlnloAa}:I jo sl.xv
©
/ _ r_ ° ,_
-a

v_ _ >_]
o _4

,-4

4-99
r_

d _

I
d N5
I
4
d 4 N

0
-ip _ '_: _,

[._ ml

o I
o 1-__. ¢1
Q

c,_ °

_D 4 rl
_
°
b
O

0
©

_D

:- r_ _= o ,'f
d 0
o
r_ b
o o
O _ _)

d'
o; 0; _- u d_
© IP PI II
V
II
II
c_
C_ II vo ,\
0
% e_

Ii

bl

r/l

©
o

_d
t_

I
_2

0 AI _I
,.Q

V _ _

.1:2_ AI _
II

4-100
0
o

a _
o _ g
o E
.a o

.0 ._
o

0
2 _
fll

,, _ _ o -_
o

_ b o "_
II

. _ _ V AI fl II _ _
_ ° ,__1-.__¢_ _
0

./.E I 1 H----_ ..... _

_.5
Ca m

4-101
o _

e_

0
o

i
u,l '_

0
o _

_-_
o
d_

_._ . ._
o 0

_._•
T_ _
0 2 _
o
[._
_ x
2_ _
m

_ +
II
_.__ ,_
+

5_
v I _e°i
i

.o o• _0
Cl "5
% II ,_

0 _ H _
rr

g)
0

>,

e_
o

! o

,.0

o
©

ff_2___ "- o

>,
ca_
ca _ z

4-102
©

L_

_,_ b_

0 o
"_ ,

r_
>

°_ "_ c_ CJ
H o

%
C)
_)

_._ _
> N o © .o o
>_ b,8

_,_
_' 0
_.,_
* o ._
_
V1 m

.j, ..1:2,

io

I
i_.

> >
o ©

07
-¢o to

II ._ _ o
% _ •
h,1

>

__) i_ c_

rn,

e_

0 >'
ca_

< m

ca_

_-103
• _ _ _ _
.,-4

II

r0 _

o_

÷ H
c_

3
o
_o _
_m ._ _ _ _ , ,
li
tn i._ o
o_ (d
°v-q 0

o "_ "o o _

_0
.r-#

?
c_ c-

r./2 .o
t3
O ×

I - u°!ln[°AaH .P) ,qPcV --

•,,,r,i

L_ rn

4-104
©

,,2
o

_ o_
I_ _', _u

©
o ll
._ .-=
_>
I

©
I-
(- _-i

-g
_4
©
_ s
>, o
>

,.4
_f i-
t-
V_
g
©
m

g _;< -e _e
a2 _
_ m ,/')
,._ o _

_ _ ,
_>' i_ _'
c_ ,_
el o
rF [_
2)
•_ _
2_ o
M
N r_ m _

: _ = _ UoTlnlOAO}{ JO s!x_ "o


o

t_q

(J I ;_1

t-

4-105
©

0
"0

(0

[/3

P_

0S

4-106
r_

"b
_ o o 0.;
I, [
b_
,,_, ,c ._

d
2
m

o o

o
_' o _ _ ,_ .2.
r_

r_ 0
,,-1 r_
¢, o
_ o_ 0
Ct _ © ,
-a <
'l:J
_ _ _''_< •
r_ o

._ _ _ _ o _ _4 ._ o

0 '_ II _'

m £ • m

_14
i>-, ..o _Q

_m

T ¸ __ o_1

_0 M

_ ca_

4-107
RE FERENCES

4-1 Donnell, L. H. and Wan, C. C., "Effect of Imperfections on Buckling of

Thin Cylinders and Columns Under Axial Compression, " Journal of Applied

Mechanics, March 1950.

4-2 March, H. W. and Kuenzi, E. W., "Buckling of Cylinders of Sandwich

Construction in Axial Compression, " FPL Report No. 1830, Revised

December 1957.

4-3 Hoff, N. J., Madsen, W. A., and Maycrs, J., "The Postbuckling Equilibritm_

of Axially Compressed Circular Cylindrical Shells, " Stanford University

Department of Aeronautics and Astronautics, Report SUDAER No. 221,

February 1965.

4-4
Anonymous, "Buckling of Thin-Walled Circular Cylinders, " NASA Space

Vehicle Design Criteria, NASA SP-8007, September 1965.

4-5 U. S. Department of Defense, Structural Sandwich Composites, MIL-HDBK-23,

30 December 1968.

4-6 Thielemann, W. F., "New Developments in the Nonlinear Theories of the

Buckling of Thin Cylindrical Shells, " Proceedings of the Durand Centennial

Conference, Held at Stanford University, 5-8 August 1969, Pergamon Press,

New York, Copyright 1960.

4-7 Zahn, J. J. and Kuenzi, E. W., "Classical Buckling of Cylinders of Sandwich

Construction in Axial Compression --- Orthotropic Cores, " U. S. Forest

Service Research Note, FPL-018, November 1963.

4-8 Donnell, L. H., "Stability of Thin-Walled Tubes Under Torsion, " NACA

Technical Report No. 479, 1934.

4-109
4-9 Scide, P., Weingarten, V. I., and Morgan, E. J., "Final Report on the

Development of Design Criteria for Elastic Stability of Thin Shell Structures, "

STL-TR-60-0000-19425, 31 December 1960.

4-10 Baker, E. H., "Ex]aerimenta] Investigation of Sanchvich Cylinders and Cones

Subjected to Axial Compression, " AIAA Journal, Volume 6, No. 9, September

1968.

4-11 Anonymous, "Status Summary Report for R&D Project 6002, " Hexce] Products,

Inc., Advanced Stm_clures Group, 25 July 1963.

4-12 Plantema, F. J., Sandwich Construction, John Wiley & Sons, Inc., New York,

Copyright 1906.

4-13 Stein, M. and Mayers, J., "Compressive Buckling of Simply Supported Curved

Plates and Cylinders of Sandwich Construction," NACA Technical Note 2601,

January 1952.

4-14 Bijlaard, P. P. and Gallagher, R. H., "Elastic Instability of a Cylindrical

Shell Under Arbitrary Circumferential Variation of Axial Stress, " Journal

of the Aerospace Sciences, Vol. 27, 1960.

4-15 Abir, l). and Nard(_, S. V., "Thermal Buckling of Circular Cylindrical Shells

Under Circumferential Temperature Gradients, " JcJurnal of the Aerospace

Sciences, Vol. 26, 1959.

4-16 Seide, P. and Weingarten, V. I., "On the Buckling of Circular Cylindrical

Shells Under Pure Bending, " Transactions of the A.S.M.E., Journal of

Applied Mechanics, March 1961.

4-17 Wang, C. T. and Sullivan, D. P., "Buckling of San_vich Cylinders Under

Bending and Combined Bending and Axial Compression, " Journal of the

Aeronautical Sciences, Vol. 19, July 1952.

4-110
4-18 Wang, C. T., Vaccaro, R. J., and DeSanto, I). F., "Buckling of Sandwich

Cylinders Under Combined Compression, Torsion, and Bending Loads, "

Journal of Applied Mechanics, Vol. 22, September 1955.

4-19 C<.llatly, R. A. and Gallagher, R. It., "Sandwich Cylinder Instability Under

Nonuniform Axial Stress, " AIAA Journal, February 1964.

4-20 Peterson, J. P. and Andersen, J. K., "Structural Behavior and Buckling

Strength of Itoneyeomb Sandwich Cylinders Subjected to Bending, " NASA

TN D-2926, August 1965.

4-21 Kucnzi, E. W., Bohannan, B., and Stevens, G. H., "Buckling Coefficients

for Sandwich Cylinders of Finite Length Under Uniform External Lateral

Pressure," U. S. Foresl Service Research Note FPL-0104, September 1965.

4-22 Raville, M. E., "Analysis of Long Cylinders of Sandwich Construction Under

Uniform External Lateral Pressure, " FPL Report No. 1844, November 1954.

4-23 Ravillc, M. E., "Supplement to Analysis of Long Cylinders of Sandwich

Construction Under Uniform External Lateral Pressure, " FPL Report No.

1844-A, February 1955.

4-24 Raville, M. E., "Buckling of Sandwich Cylinders of Finite Length Under

Uniform External Lateral Pressure, " FPL Report No. 1844-B, May 1955.

4-25 Norris, C. B. and Zahn, J. J., "Design Curves for the Buckling of Sandwich

Cylinders of Finite Length Under Uniform External Lateral Pressure, " FPL

Report No. 1869, May 1959.

4-26 Norris, C. B. and Zahn, J. J., "Design Curves for the Buckling of Sandwich

Cylinders of Finite Length Under Uniform External Lateral Pressure,"

U. S. Forest Service Research Note FPL-07, 1963.

4-27 Kazimi, M. I., "Sandwich Cylinders Part II - Uniformity of the Mechanical

Properties of the Core, " Aerospace Engineering, September 1960.

4-iii
4-28 Jenkinson, P. M. and Kuenzi, E. W., "The Buckling Under External Radial

Pressure and Buckling Under Axial Compression of Sanchvich Cylindrical

Shells, " FPL Report PE-227, January 1962.

4-29 C_rard, G., "Torsional Instability of a Long San(hvich Cylinder, " Proc. 1st

U. S. Natl. Congr. Appl. Mech., Copyright 1951.

4-30 March, H. W. and Kuenzi, E. W., "Buckling of Sandwich Cylinders in

Torsion, " FPL Report No. 1840 Revised, January 1958.

4-31 Gerard, G., Introduction to Structural Stability Theory, McGraw-Itill Book

Company, Inc., New York, Copyright 19(;2.

4-32 Timoshenko, S. P. and Gere, J. M., Theory of Elastic Stability, McGraw-

Hill Book Company, Inc., New York, Copyright 1961.

4-33 Lundquist, E. E., "Strength Tests of Thin-Walled Duralumin Cylinders in

Combined Transverse Shear and Bending, " NACA TN 523, 1935.

4 -34 Lundquist, E. E. and Burke, W. F., "StrenKth Tests of Thin-Walled

Duralumin Cylinders of Elliptic Section, " NACA TN 527, 1935.

4-35 Gerard, G. and Becker, H., "Handbook of Structural Stability, Part II1 -

Buckling of Curved Plates and Shells, " NACA TN 3783, August 1957.

,t-36 Batdorf, S. B., Stein, M., and Schildcrout, M., "Critical Stress of Thin-

Walled Cylinders in Torsion, " NACA TN 1.244, 194_.

4-37 Maki, A. C., "Elastic Stability of Cylindrical Sandwich Shells Under Axial

and Lateral Load, " U. S. Forest Service Research Note FPL-0173, October

1967.

4-38 Batdorf, S. B., Stein, M., and Schildcrout, M., "Critical Combinations of

Torsion and Direct Axial Stress for Thin-Walled Cylinders, " NACA Technical

Note 1345, June 1947.

4-112
5
GENERAL INSTABILITY OF TRUNCATED CIRCULAR CONES

5.1 AXIAL COMPRESSION

5.1.1 Basic Principles

It appears that no significant theoretical solutions have been published for axially com-

pressed sandwich cones. Therefore, for the purposes of this handbook, the equivalent-

cylinder concept of Seide, eta!. [5-11 has been adopted as a practical expediency.

Based on a large array of test data from thin-walled, isotropie (non-sandwich), trun-

cated cones, Seide, et al. concluded that the critical stresses for such cones can be

taken equal to the values for circular cylinders which satisfy the following conditions:

a. The wall thickness of the equivalent cylinder is equal to that of the cone.
In the ease of sandwich constructions, the logical extension of this con-
dition is that the equivalent cylinder have the same facing and core thick-
nesses found in the cone.

b. The radius of the equivalent cylinder is equal to the finite principal radius
of curvature at the small end of the cone.

c. The length of the equivalent cylinder is equal to the slant length of the
e one.

In Reference 5-2, Baker presents test data from two axially compressed, truncated

sandwich cones having vertex half-angles equal to 15 degrees. These data were used

in conjunction with the foregoing equivalent-cylinder concept to arrive at knock-down

factors _c" The results are shown in Figure 5.1-i, along with data obtained from

5-1
!!

i i

+ t
_t

t !
2_
I

4 J ,

-ill

i!:

I I

5-2
axially compressedsandwichcylinders. This figure alsoincludesthe designcurve

recommended
in Section4.2.2 for suchcylinders. It canbe seenthat the datafrom

the conesare in favorableagreementwith the results obtainedfrom cylinders. This

providesat least a small degreeof experimentalsubstantiationfor application(>_


the

equivalent-cylinderapproachto sand_vich
cones. However,in view of the scarcity of

test points from conicalspecimens,this methodcanpresentlybe consideredas only

a "best-available"criterion.

5-3
5.1.2 Design Equations and Curves

For simply supported, truncated, right-circular, sandwich cones subjected to axial

compression, the critical stresses a and a (for facings 1 and 2 respectively)


crl cG

may be computed from the equations and curves of Section 4.2.2, provided that the

following substitutions are made:

So
The values
• t_, t_, tC , and h are measured as shown in Figure 5.1-2.
(There is no preference as to which facing is denoted by the subscripts
1 or2.)

6
The radius R is replaced by the effective radius R shown in Figure 5.1-2.
e


The length L is replaced by the effective length L shown in Figure 5.1-2.
e

Both Ends

Simply Supported

Axis of
P, lbs
P, lbs Revolution
R
small
View A

N()F}:
t 1, 12 t , h, I_"lll a] r ' let ' a_ld

[ c art all o_t a,l_rttl ul IllrJlq (i I

it1( hes w]li}t ¸ _ I_ r41ca_url'd irl

Figure 5.1-2. Truncated Sandwich Cone Subjected to Axial Compression

5-4
The applied axial load P and the computed stresses are associated with the directions

indicated in Figure 5.1-2. In addition, since the maximum stresses occur at the small

end of the cone, the critical values are associated with this location. For both elastic

and inelastic cases, one can therefore write

Pcr = 2_Re ((rcr It_ +_cr_t_) cos2_ (5.1-I)

where

Rsmall
R - (5. i-2)
e cos o_

It is recommended that the approach specified here be applied only to cases where

_ 30 degrees.

Plasticity reduction factors should always be based on the stress at the small end of

the cone (see Section 9).

5-5
5.2 PURE BENDING

5.2.1 Basic Principles

It appears that no significant theoretical solutions have been published for sandwich

cones subjected to pure bending. Therefore, for the purposes of this handbook, the

equivalent-cylinder concept of Seide, et al. has been adopted as a practical expediency.

Based on a large array of test data from thin-walled, isotropic (non-sandwich), trun-

cated cones, Seide, et al. concluded that the critical peak stresses for such cones can

be taken equal to the corresponding values for circular cylinders which satisfy the

following conditions:

a° The wall thickness of the equivalent cylinder is equal to that of the cone.
In the case of sandwich constructions, the logical extension of this condi-
tion is that the equivalent cylinder have the same facing and core thick-
nesses as are found in the cone.

b. The radius of the equivalent cylinder is equal to the finite principal radius
of curvature at the small end of the cone.

c. The length of the equivalent cylinder is equal to the slant length of the cone.

No test data are available for sandwich cones which are of the types considered in this

handbook and are subjected to pure bending. Therefore, the validity of the method

recommended here has not been experimentally verified and can only be considered as

a "best-available" approach.

5-6
5.2.2 Design Equations and Cu_wes

For simply supported, truncated, right-circular, san_vich cones subjected to pure

bending, the critical peak stresses _ and ff (for facings 1 and 2, respectively)
e r 1 c r>

may be computed from the equations and curves of Section 4.:'.2, provided that the

folh_ving substitutions are made:

a. The values t_, t.z, re, and h are measured as shown in Figure 5.2-1.
(There is no preference as to which facing is denoted by the subseripts

1 or 2.)

b. The radius R is replaced by the effective radius R e shown in Figure 5.2-1.

c. The length L is replaced by the effeetive length L e shown in Figure 5.2-1.

[
1

"r C - Axis
a_nraJll \ r<evoIut ;;_n
View A

Rsmall

L
Note:
tl, t2, t c, h, R small' Re, and 1, e

are all measured in units of inches

while Olis measured in degrees.

Figure 5.2-1. Truncated Sandwich Cone Subjected to Pure Bending

5-7
The applied bending moment M and the computed stresses are associated with the

directions indicated in Figure 5.2-1. In addition, since the maximum stresses occur

at the small end of the cone, the critical values are associated with this location.

When the behavior is elastic, one can therefore write

Mcr = _r R 2e ((Ycr 1 tl +Crcr_t2) cos 3(_ (5.2-1)

whe re

Rsmall
R = (5.2-2)
e cos (_

To compute M cr when the behavior is inelastic, one must resort to numerical inte-

gration techniques.

It is recommended that the approach specified here be applied only to cases where

o_ _ 30 degrees.

Plasticity reduction factors should always be based on the peak compressive stress at

the small end of the cone (see Section 9).

5-8
5.3 EXTERNAL LATERAL PRESSURE

5.3.1 Basic Principles

The loading condition considered here is depicted in Figure 5.3-1. As shown, the cone

is subjected to a uniform external lateral pressure. The axial component of this loading

o_ R R
i
-I-
R
smal 1 F
%
R
large

!
w c, lbs/in

Figure 5.3-1. Truncated Cone Subjected to Uniform External Lateral Pressure

is reacted by a uniform compressive running load at the large end of the cone. This

results in principal membrane stresses which may be computed as follows, when the

core has a relatively high extensional stiffness in the direction normal to the facings:

P Ram (5.3-!)
(YH - (t_ + t_)

(TM (t_ + tp) 2c-_s _ R (5.3-2)

5-9
where

R (5.3-3)
R_ - cos (_

and

(YH = Hoop membrane stress, psi.

(rM = Meridional membrane stress, psi.

p = Uniform external lateral pressure, psi.

= Finite principal radius of curvature of middle surface, inches.

= Thicknesses of the facings, inches. {There is no preference as


to which facing is denoted by the subscripts 1 or 2.)

R = Radius of middle surface measured perpendicular to the axis of


revolution, inches.

Radius of middle surIace, at small end of cone, measured per-


Rsmal 1 =
pendicular to the axis of revolution, inches.

Radius of middle surface, at large end of cone, measured per-


Rlarg e =
pendicular to the axis of revolution, inches.

= Vertex half-angle of cone, degrees.

Since the radii R and I_ vary with the axial location, the stresses ¢YH and a M are non-

uniform over the conical surface. The maximum values for each of these quantities

occur at the large end of the cone.

It appears that no significant theoretical solutions have been published for the stability

of truncated sandwich cones which are subjected to uniform external hydrostatic pres-

sure. Therefore, for the purposes of this handbook, the equivalent-cylinder approach

suggested in Reference 5-11 has been adopted as a practical expediency. Based on

this method, the critical lateral pressure for the truncated cone may be taken equal

5-10
to that for anequivalentcircular sandwichcylinderwhichsatisfies the following
conditions:

a. Thefacingandcorethicknessesof the equivalentcylinder are the same


as thosefoundin the cone.

b. Thelengthof the equivalentcylinder is equalto the slant lengthof thc conc.

c. The radius ofthe equivalentcylinder is equalto the averagefinite principal


radius of curvatureof the cone. Thatis,

Rsmal 1 + Rlarg e
R = (5.3-4)
e 2 cos

The critical lateral pressure for the equivalent cylinder can be obtained by using the

equations and curves of Section 4.4.2.

Since no test data are available from truncated sandwich cones subjected to external

lateral pressure, the reliability of the foregoing approach has not been experimentally

verified and can only be considered as a "best-available" technique.

5-11
5.3.2 Design Equations and Curves

For a simply supported, truncated, right-circular, sandwich cone subjected to uni-

form, external, lateral pressure, the critical pressure may be taken equal to the

critical lateral pressure for an equivalent sandwich cylinder which satisfies the

following:

a, The values t_, t:., tc, and h are measured as shown in Figure 5.3-2.

b. The length is taken equal to the slant length L .


e

c. The radius is denoted R and is computed from the formula


e

Rsmal 1 + Rlarg e
R = (5.3-5)
e 2 cos_

where Rsmal 1, Rlarg e, and _ are as shown in Figure 5.3-2.

t k_\
,..--- BOTH ENDS VIEW A
SIMPLY SUPPORTED

tl, t 2, Ic, h, R, R2, Rsmall,, Rlarge'


a_d Lu aR: all measured it] units of

in{'hcs while _ is measured in degrees,


NOTE:

Figure 5.3-2. Truncated Sandwich Cone

5-12
The critical lateral pressurefor the equivalentsandwichcylinder canbe obtainedby

usingthe equation,_
andcurvesof Section4.4.2.

Plastieily c_)nsiderations
shouldbehandledas specified in Section 9.2. Tile plasticity

roduclion factor 77 should always be based on theprincit)al nlembrane stresses at the

lat-ge end of the cone where

P R1 arge
= in. 3-6)
_I! (L _ t:.) cos q

P Re ( R_m_ll /
_M - (L t_) \1 -- (5.3-7)
. ' _ Rlarg e /

It is ruconm_(,nded thai the at)l)roach specified here be applied only to cases where

c_ _ 30 degrees.

5-13
5.4 TORSION

5.i. 1 BasicPrinciples

It appearsthat no significantlheoreticalsolutionshavebeen1)ublished
for sandwich

conessubjectedto torsion. Therefore, for thepurl)(,s(,s,)1this handbook,the

equivalent-cylinderconcepl()t'Seide[5-3i hasbeenadopledas a practical expediency.

Basedonthe analysisof his numericalcomputationsfor lhin-walled, isotropie {non-

sand_vich),
truncatedcones,Scideconcludedthat the critical l¢)rquesfor suchshells

canbe takenequallo the valuesfor circular cylinderswhichsalisfy the following

conditions:

a. The wall thickness of the equivalent cylinder is equal to that of the cone.
In the case of sandwich constructions, the logical extension of this condi-
tion is that the equivalent cylinder have the same facing and core thick-
nesses as arc found in the cone.

[?. The leng-th of the equivalent cylinder is equal to the axial length of the cone.

c, The radius of the equivalent cylinder is coml)uted from the relationshit)

'lc :: (Rsmall cosc_)1 I[( R _. _ 1 _ R---_---_maH/j- 1 1 )I/larg_eRsmall >]1 ,,5.4-1)

where

R = Radius of equivalent cylinder, inches.


C

It = Radius at small end of cone, inches (measured perpendicular


small
to the axis of revolution).

Rlarg c :: Radius at large end of cone, inch(_s (measured perpendicular


to the axis of revolution).

cy :_ Vertex half-angle of cone, degrees.

5-14
In R(_ference 5-1, Seide, et al. present test results from ten isotropic (non-sandwich),

truncated cones which were subjected to torsion. These tests included specim¢,ns

having vertex half-angles (c_ of both 30 and (;0 degrees. The agreement of these,

results with equivalent-cylinder predictions was similar to that obtained from com-

parisons of test data from isotropic (non-sandwich) cylinders against the corresponding

small-deflection theoretical solutions. For conical sandwich constructions it was

therefore decided to use the same knock-down factor (7 s = 0.80) as was selected in

Section 4.5 for sandwich cylinders under torsion.

No test data are available for sandwich cones which are of the t33)es considered in this

handbook and are subjected to torsion. Therefore the method recommended here has

not been ex-perimentally verified and can only be considered as a "best-available"

approach.

5-15
5.,1.2 Design Equations and Curves

For simply supported, truncated, right-circular sanck_'ich cones subjected to torsion,

the critical torque may be computed from the equation

T = 2vR z (t t + t._) y_ (5.4-2)


er e • cr

where

T Critical torque for sandwich cone subjected to torsion, in-lbs.


cr

R =: Radius of equivalent sandwic:h cylinder, inches r see Equation


o
(5.,,_-3)].

t 1 and t2 = Ttticknesses of the facings, inches. (There is no preference


as to which faeing is denoted by the subscript 1 or 2.)

/
T = Critieal shear stress for equivalent sandwich cylinder when
cr
subjected to torsion, psi. (it should be noted that this value is
not equal to the critical sh,-ar stress of the conical sandwich
construction. )

The radius R is coml)uted from


e

1 1

(,_. 4-:_')
Re = (Rsmal 1 c_)scs) 1 + [2 (1 + Rlarge_]'- [1(I + Rlar_e_] -_
Rsmall/] Rsmall/l

where Rsmal 1, Rlarg e, and c_ are as shown in Figure 5.4-1.

The stress 7_ may be computed from the equations and cur_'es of Section 4.5.2 pro-
or

vided that

a. The values t_, t_, te, and d are measured as shown in Figure 5.4-1.

bg The radius R is replaced by the effective radius R .


e

co The length L is taken equal to the axial length of the cone (see Figure
5.4-1).

5-16
Both Ends

Simply Supported /

7 d .!

( R
i

small

Axis of

Revolution
l, Hl-/bs

T, itl-lbs View A

N _Tt- i1, 12, it, l/, tl, I, P'srl_al[,

aud Rlarg c art al_ illtasclr_ tl


ill II[lllS O[ il_C lies wllilt' t+_ iS

rneastlrt d i_ (t('_rt cs,

Figure 5.4-1. Truncated Sandwich Cone Subjected to Torsion

In a truncated cone which is subjected to torsion, the maximum shear stress will occur

at the small end. Hence, for sandwich constructions of this type, the critical stress

value is associated with that same location. One can therefore write

T
cr

rcr = 2rr R _ (t_+t 2) (5.4-4)


small

where

r = Critical shear stress for truncated sandwich cone when subjected


cr
to torsion, psi.

It is recommended that the approach specified here be applied only to cases where

_ 30 degrees.

Plasticity reduction factors should always be based on the stress at the small end of

the cone (see Section 9).

5-17
:).;_ TRANSVERSE SIIEAR

5.5.1 Basic Principles

Th(, case considered here is that of a truncated sandwich cone which is subjected only

to transverse shear forces a,_ shown in Fig_,re 5.5-1. No_c that all transverse see-

tions, such as A-A, are subjected to the same magnitude <)f shear load.

--,.-- A

J l.i

____ --

_.--A

Figxlre 5.5-1. Truncated Cone Subjected to Transverse Shear

This, of course, is a pur_qy h3_pothetical loading condition since it does not result in

over-all static equilibrium of the structure. To obtain the necessary balance of forces

and moments, it is required that an external bending moment also be present. Never-

theless, the hypothetical unbalanced loading system does prove to be of interest since

the combined effects of transverse shear and its associated bending are usually analy-

zed by using an interaction equation. Such a relationship invulves both the critical

peak meridional stress under a bending moment acting alone and the critical peak

shear stress corresponding to the subject artificial loading condition.

It appears that no significant theoretical solutions have been published for sandwich

cones subjected to transverse shear. Therefore, for the purposes of this handbook,

5-18
the conceptusedfor sandwichcylinders (see Section 4.6) will also be adopted here as

a practical expediency. As noted in Section 4.6, the results from a series of tests

[5-4 and 5-5] on isotropic (non-sanchvieh), circular and elliptic cylinders led to the

conclusion [5-6] that

Lower-Bonndrcr TestValues for 1


Transverse Shear Loading _ 1.25 (5.5-1)

Small-Deflection Theoretical ]
rcr Values for Torsional Loading]

To properly understand this ratio, it should be observed that for torsional loading of a

thin-walled circular cross section the shear stress Tcr is uniformly distributed around

the circumference. On the other hand, under transverse shear loading, the shear

stress is nonuniform and the value _'cr then corresponds to the peak intensity which

occurs at the neutral axis.

For the lack of a better approach, it was reconm_ended in Section 4.6 that Equation

(5.5-1) be used for the design and analysis of sandwich cylinders that are subjected to

transverse shear forces. For the same reason, it is recommended here that Equa-

tion (5.5-1) also be used for truncated sandwich cones. In the latter ease, the re-

quired small-deflection theoretical Tcr values for torsional loading should be obtained

as specified in Section 5.4, with the exception that 7s must now be taken equal to unity.

No sanchvich test data are available to substantiate the reliability of this practice.

Until such data do become available, one can only regard this proeedm_e as a "best-

available" approach.

5-19
5.5.2 DesignEquationsandCurves

For simply supported,right-circular, truncatedsandwichconessubjectedto trans-

verse shearforces, the critical peakshearstress maybe comtmtedfrom theequation

= 1.25 (T) (5.5-2)


rcr cr Torsion

Ys 1.0
where

(_r) = The critical torsional shear stress obtained by substituting


Torsion Ys = 1.0 throughout the meth_gls cited in Section 5.4, psi.
Ys = 1.0

In a truncated cone which is subjected to transverse shear, the maximum shear stress

will occur at the small end. ttence, the critical stress value is associated with that

1ocation.

Plasticity reduction factors should always be based on the stress at the small end of the

cone (see Section 9).

When the behavior is elastic, the critical transverse shear force .._Fv)cr can be corn-

puted from the following:

(F v) cr = _ Rsmall (t_ +%)r (5.5-3)


cr

To compute (Fv)cr when the behavior is inelastic, one must resort to numerical inte-

gration techniques.

5-20
5.6 COMBINED LOADING CONDITIONS

5.6.1 General

For structural members subjected to combined loads, it is customary to represent

critical loading conditions by means of so-called interaction curves. Figure 5.6-1

shows the graphic format usually used for this purpose. The quantity R i is the ratio

of an applied load or stress to the critical value for that type of loading when acting

alone. The quantity" Rj is similarly defined for a second type of loading. Curves of

this form give a very clear picture as to the structural integrity of particular con-

figurations. All computed points which fall within the area bounded by the interaction

curve and the coordinate axes correspond to stable structures. All points lying on

or outside of the interaction curve indicate that buckling will occur. Furthermore,

as shown in Figure 5.6-1, a measure of the margin of safety is given by the ratio of

distances from the actual loading point to the curve and to the origin. For example,

assume that a particular structure is subjected to the combined loading condition

corresponding to point B of Figure 5.6-1.

(Rj)
D -- -- -- M
I

1.0
(Rj) B --__

Rj 1/111

0 ].0
Ri

Figure 5.6-I. Sample Interaction Curve

5-21
Then, for proportional increases in R. and R., the margin of safety (MS) can be com-
1 j

puted from the following:

(Rj) D
MS - i
(Rj) B (5.6-1)

As an alternative procedure, one might choose to compute a minimum margin of safety

which is based on the assumption that loading beyond point B follows the path BM.

Point M is located in such a position that BM is the shoo-test line that can be drawn

between point B and the interaction curve. The minimum margin of safety can then

be calculated as follows:

Minimum MS - OB + BM 1
OB (5.6-2)

5-22
5.6.2 Axial Compression Plus Bending

5.6.2.1 Basic Principles

In Section 4.7.2 this loading condition is treated for the case of circular sandwich

cylinders. For such configurations, it was concluded that one may use the following

interaction relationship:

(5.6-3)
R c +%=1

where

c
R = (5.6-4)
c "/c ((_c) C L

ab
(5.6-5)
%= Tb ((_c)
CL

and
= Uniform compressive stress due solely to applied axial load,
(Y
c
psi.

= Pcak compressive stress due solely to applied bending moment,


_b
psi.

= Classical theoretical value for critical uniform compressive


(_c)C L stress under an axial load acting alone, psi.

Tc = Knock-down factor given by Figure 4.2-8, dimensionless.

Tb = Knock-down factor given by Figure 4.3-2, dimensionless.

In this handbook it is proposed that for truncated sandwich cones the cases of pure

bending and of axial load acting alone both be treated by means of an equivalent-

cylinder concept (see Sections 5.1 and 5.2). For both types of loading, the radius

of the equivalent cylinder is taken equal to the finite principal radius of curvature at

the small end of the cone. It should be noted that the maximum stresses from both
5-23
bendingandaxial compressionoccurat this samelocation. In viewof theseseveral

considerations,it is assumedherethatEquations(5.6-2,)through(5.6-5) canbe


appliedto truncatedsanchvich
conesif

a,

o"c and gb are bcCh computed for the meridional direction and at the small
end of the cone, and

b.

the values for ;¢e' and Yb' and ((Te)r_T are those which apply to the equivalent
sandwich cylinder described in Sect_i_ns 5.1 and 5.2. (It is important to
keel) in mind that 7c must be taken equal to 1.0 when computing the value
((_c) C L • )

Since no test data have been published for truncated, sandwich cones subjected to axial

compression plus bending, the recommended approach has not been experimentally

verified and can only be regarded as a "best-available,, method.

5-24
5.6.2.2 DesignEquationsandCurves

For simply supported,truncated, right-circular sandwichconessubjectedto axial

compressionplusbending,the followinginteractionequationmaybeemployed:

Re+ Rb = 1 (5.6-6)
where

c
R - (5.6-7)
c 7e (6c)CL

_b

ab 7t) (5c) (,_.(i-s)


CL

Equation (5.6-6) may be used for cones of any length. A plot of this equation is given

in Figure 5.6-2.

The quantity gc is the uniform meridional compressive stress, at the small end of the

cone, due to the axial force acting alone.

The quantity Crb is the peak meridional compressive stress, at the small end of the

cone, due to the bending moment acting alone.

The quantities Ye' _b' and (Cre)CL- are those which apply to the equivalent sandwich

cylinder described in Sections 5.1 and 5.2.

In Equations (5.6-7) and (5.6-8), the knock-down factors )'e and_b are those obtained

from Figures 4.2-8 and 4.3-2, respectively.

The quantity (_c)CL is simply the result obtained by using Yc = 1.0 in the method of

Section 4.2.2.

5-25
Plasticity considerationsshouldbehandledas specificdin Section9.2 except,that in

this case, one may use

(a)
[ l
r? -: [ _-]--_
1 1 EZ for short cones, and

(b) r7 =
Ii- VEtEs
o l for moderate-length through long cones.
1---_ l Ef

The plasticity reduction factor 77 should always be based on the peak compressive stress

at the small end of the cone.

1.0t
I 'iii

0.8

\ ........ T

0.6

It b

O. 4 ................... 4-.......... ' ' ' _ ' ' _ -

..... r t

!
0.2 1 _
i I '

0 i .
0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 .0
R
e

Figure 5.6-2. Design Interaction Curve for Truncated Sandwich Cones


Subjected to Axial Compression Plus Bending

5-2 6
5.6.3 Uniform External Itydrostatic Pressure

5.6.3.1 Basic Principles

The loading condition considered here is depicted in Figure 5.6-3. As shcavn, the cone

is subjected to a uniform external pressure over the lateral surface and both cnd closures.

Both Ends
Simply SuppoEtLd

p, psi

c_ R Rz

-I
p, psi

..q-_
_t_
Rlarg c

Figure 5.6-3. Truncated Cone Subjected to Uniform


External Itydrostatic Pressure

This results in principal membrane stresses which may be computed as follows when

the core has a relatively high extensional stiffness in the direction normal to the

facings:

p R_

CrH - (t_ + t_) (5.6-9)

pR._ (5.6-10)
cr M - 2 (t_ + t_)

where

R
R - (5.6-11)
2 cos

5-27
and

=: Itoop membrane stress, psi.

- Meridional membrane stress, psi.


crM
p - Uniform external hydrostatic pressure, psi.

Finite principal radius of curvature of middle surface, inches.

tI andt -- Thicknesses of the facings, inches. (There is no preference


as to which facing is denoted 1)3, the subscripts 1 or 2.)

R : Radius of middle surface measured perpendicular to the axis


of revolution, inches.

(_ = Vertex half-angle of cone, degrees.

and r; are non-


Since the radii [/ and R vary with the axial location, the stresses (Ytt M

uniform over the conical surface. The maximum values for each of these quantities

occur at the large end of the cone.

It appears that no significant theoretical solutions have been published for the stability

of truncated sandwich c(mes which are subjected lo uniform external hydrostatic pres-

sure. Therefore, i'or lh(, purposes of this handbook, _he equivalent-cylinder at)preach

of Seide, et al. [5-11 has been adopted as apractical expediency. Based on alarge

array of test data from thin-walled, isotropic (non-sandwich), cylinders and truncated

cones, Scide, et al. concluded that the critical hydrostatic pressures for such cones

can be taken equal to the values for equivalent circular cylinders which satisfy" the

following conditions:

a. The wall thickness of the equivalent cylinder is equal to that of the cone.
In the case of sanokvich constructions, the logical extension of this condi-
tion is thai the equivalent cylinder have the same facing and core thick-
nesses as are found in the cone.

5-28
b° The length of the equivalent cylinder is equal to the slant length of the cone.

C. The radius of the equivalent cylinder is equal to the average finite principal
radius of eurvature of the cone. That is,

Rsmall + Rlarge (5.6-12)


R -:
e 2cos

where

R = Radius of middle surface for equivalent cylinder, inches.


e

R = Radius of middle surface at small end of cone (measured


small
perpendicular to the axis of revolution), inches.

= Radius of middle surface at large end of cone (measured


Rlargc
perpendicular to the taxis of revolution), inches.

The critical hydrostatic pressure for the equivalent cylinder can be obtained by using

the equations and curves of Section 4.7.3.

The only available eN)erimental results for conical san&vieh shells under uniform

external hydrostatic pressure are the data from two tests eondueted by North American

Rock, veil, Corp. _5-7 and 5-8_ in conjunction with the Navajo missile program. To

assist in the preparation of this handbook, an analysis was made of the result published

in Reference 5-7. The other specimen was not studied since it was stressed too deeply

into the plastic region. The specimen of Reference 5-7 was also inelastic but the

stresses in this instance were low enough to permit reliable computations. Using the

approach of the present section in conjunction with the plasticity reduction criteria of

Sect{on 9, the design critieal pressure was computed to bc 36.4 psi. This is in satis-

faclot3' agreement with the experimental value of 43.6 psi.

5 ')9
The foregoingsubstantiates,to a very small degree,the reliability of the equivalent-

cylinder conceptrecommended
here. However,in viewof the lack of a sufficient

numberof test results, this approachcanpresentlybe consideredas only a "best-


available"method.

5-30
5.6.3.2 Design Equations and Curves

I,'or a simply supported, truncated, right-circular sandwich cone subjected 1o uniform,

external, hydrostatic pressure, the critical pressure may be taken equal to that for tin

equivalent sandwich cylinder for which

a. The values t_, t:., t c, and h are measured as shown in Figure 5.6-4.

of the cone as shown in


b. The length is taken equal to the slant length Le

Figx_re 5.6-<1.

C0 The radius is denoted R and is computed from the fornmla


e

Rsmal 1 + Rlarg e
R = (5.6-13)
e 2cos (_

where Rsmal 1, Rlarg e, and a are as shown in Figure 5.6-4.

, Rlargc
R R2

L_L\I
_-T
VIEW A
P'smail
BOTH ENDS
SIMPLY SUPPORTED

NOTE: t 1, l,. i c , h, R, R,2 Rslnall' Rlarge'


and Le are all measured in units of
inches while o/is measured in degrees.

Figure 5.6-4. Truncated Sandwich Cone

The critical hydrostatic pressure for the equivalent sandwich cylinder can be obtained

from the equations and curves of Section 4.7.3 if the ratios R and R are now defined
c p

as follows :

5-31
R = P
c ye (l_x)C L (5.6-14)

P
R =
(5. (;-15)
p Wp (_y)CL
w he re

p
Uniform, external, hydrostatic pressure applied to lateral
surfaces and end closures of the equivalent sandwich cylinder,
psi.

In Equations (5.6-14) and (5.6-15), the knoek-d(r_cn factor _/e is that obtained from

Figure 4.2-8, while v may be taken equal to 0.90.


'p

It should be noted that

(Px)CL Re
((rx) CL - 2 (t_ * t:_) (5.6-16)

or

2 (gx)CL(t ! _ t_)
(ISx)CL = R (5.6-17)
e

whe re

(C_x)CL = Classical theoretieal value for critical uniform axial com-


pressive stress when acting alone on the equivalent sandwich

cylinder. This value can be obtained by using Yc = 1.0 in the


equations and curves of Section 4.2.

The value (tSy)c L can be obtained by using Tp = 1.0 in the equations and curves of

Section 4.4.

Plasticity considerations should be handled as specified in Section 9.2. The plasticity

reduction factor r7 should always be based on the principal membrane stresses at the

large end of the cone where,

5-32
pR large
(5.G-18)
(YH= (t1 _ t2) (cos _)

P Rlarg e
(5. (;-19)
_M = 2 (t 1 + t_) (cos (_)

It is recommended that the approach specified here be applied only to cases where

_ 30 degrees.

5-33
5.6.4 Axial CompressionPlus Torsion

5.6.4.1 Basic Principles

Theloadingconditionconsideredhereis depictedin Figure 5.t;-5. Theaxial load P

canoriginatefrom anysourceincludingexternalpressureswhichare distributed

uniformly over the endclosures.

T, m-lbs torque

], Hl-lbs (orqtle_

f_ / \\
P. I bs

_.__________ ____ _ _ _ ___ _ P, l bs

Bol:h Ends

Simply Supported

Figure 5.6-5. Truncated Cone Subjected to Axial


Compression Plus Torsion

It appears that no significant theoretical solutions have been published for the stability

of truncated sanchvich cones under this combination of loads, ltowevcr, MacCalden

and Matthiesen _5-9] have arrived at certain conclusions for non-sandwich shells under

such loading and, for the purposes of this handbook, these results provide the basis for

an expedient engineering approach to the case of conical sandwich constructions. Based

on a large array of test data from Mylar specimens, MacCalden and Matthiesen con-

cluded that the following interaction relationship could be applied to thin-walled, iso-

tropic (non-sanchvich), truncated cones:

R +R _ = 1
c S (5.6-20)

5-34
where

R :2
P (5.6-21)
c m

(Pcr)Empirical

R T (5.6-22)
s
(Ter) Empirical

and

= Empirical lcnver-bound value for the critical axial load


(Pcr) Empirical
when acting alone, lbs.

= Empirical lower-bound value for the critical torque when


(Tcr) Empirical
acting alone, in-lbs.

This result is identical to that given in Reference 5-10 for thin-walled, isotropic (non-

sandwich) cylinders subjected to axial compression plus torsion. One might, therefore,

conjecture that in the case of sandwich constructions the interaction curves for trun-

cated cones under the subject loading condition are of the same shape as those pre-

sented in Section 4.7.4.2 for circular cylinders. The design equations and curves

recommended here arc based on this premise. That is, one might choose to view the

formula,

R + R2 = 1 (5.6-23)
c s

as a comprehensive interaction equation for truncated cones of both isotropic (non-

sanchvich) and sanchvich construction. However, it is important to note here that

MacCalden and Matthicsen observed that the presence of even a very small axial load

made the torsionally-loaded conical shell much more sensitive to imperfections than

was the case when no axial load was applied at all. They, therefore, recommended

that whenever R c is non-zero, the same knock-down factor be employed in computing

5-35
m

(Tcr)Empirica 1 as is used in the calculation of (Pcr)Empirieal" It was further speci-

fied that this single knock-down factor should be taken equal to that which applies for

the case of axial compression acting alone. The same practice is adopted here.

Caution should be exercised in implementing the foregoing recommendations, partially

because only the extremes o[ transverse shear rigidity of the core have been consid-

ered (see Section 4.7.4.1). In addition, although the interaction relationship for the

subject loading condition should probably be dependent upon a length parameter, no

investigations were made to establish the sandwich lengths over which Equation (5.6-23)

is a reasonable representation of the actual behavior. Furthermore, no test data have

been obtained for sandwich cones subjected to axial compression plus torsion. There-

fore, the general validity of Equation (5.6-23) has not been experimentally verified

and can only be regarded as a "best-available" approach.

5-36
5.6.4.2 DesignEquationsandCurves

For simply supported,truncated,right-circular sandwichconessubjectedto axial

compressionplustorsion, onemight chooseto employthe interactionformLda,

(5.6-24)
R +R e =1
C S

which is plotted in Figure 5.6-6 and where,


P
(5.6-25)

c (Per)Empirical

T (5.6-26)

- 3,c

p = Applied axial load, lbs.

T = Applied torque, in-lbs.

Lower-bound value for the critical axial load when


(Pcr)Empirical acting alone. This value can be obtained by using the
equations and curves of Section 5.1.2, lbs.

Lower-bound value for the critical torque when acting


(Tcr)Empirica 1= alone. Tkis value can be obtained by using the equa-
tions and curves of Section 5.4.2, in-lbs.

The knock-down factor obtained from Figure 4.2-8


_C
(dimensionless). For the purposes of the present
case, the quantity R (see Figure 4.2-8) must be set
equal to the equivalent radius R e which is computed
as follows:

R
small (5.6-27)
Re = cosc_

R = Radius at small end of cone, inches (measured per-


small pendicular to the axis of revolution).

= Vertex half-angle of cone, degrees.


5-37
0 O. 2 0.4

Figure 5.6-6.
Conditional Interaction Curve for Truncated Sandwich Cones
Subjected to Axial Compression :Plus Torsion

The factor _ should be introduced into the demoninator of the ratio R s only when

R c is non-zero. For the special case where no axial load is present (R c 0), Rs

should be taken equal to T + (Ter)Empirical"

Attention is drawn to the fact that in Section 5.6.4.1, several factors are cited which

shed considerable doubt upon the reliability of results obtained from the indiscriminate

use of Equation (5.6-24) mid Figure 5.6-6. In view of these uncertainties, one might

often choose to employ the straight-line interaction formula,

R +It =1
c s (5.6-28)

which is plotted in Figure 5.6-7. This relationship can be used with confidence for

any length of cone and for any region of transverse shear rigidity of the core, since
5-3 8
experiencehas shownthat the linear interactionformulais neveruneonservative
for

shell stability problems, ttowever, in manyeasesit will, of course, introduce

excessiveconservatism.

Plasticity considerationsshouldbehandledas specifiedin Section9.2. Theplasticity

reductionfactor r{ should always be based on the stresses at the small end of the cone.

0o

0.4

li

(Ii 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0

R e

Figure 5.6-7. Conservative Interaction Curve for Truncated Sandwich Cones


Subjected to Axial Compression Plus Torsion

5.6.5 Other Loading Combinations

5.6.5.1 Basic Principles

In Section 5.6.4, the combined loading condition of axial compression plus torsion is

treated. The interaction relationships presented there can be used for an additional

5-39
loadingcombination1)5, recognizing that at any given axial location on the cone the

peak meridional stress due to an applied bending moment can be converted into an

equivalent uniform meridional stress. With this in mind, the design equations and

era'yes of Section 5.6.4.2 can be used for the combination of axial compression plus

bending plus torsion which is depicted in Figure 5.6-S.

Fig_lre 5, 6-8.
Truncated Cone Subjected to Axial Compression
Plus Bending Plus Torsion

To accomplish this it is simply required tlmt the quantity Rc be redefined as follows:

p#

R
c (tScr) .... (o. 6-29)
r_mplmcal

whcre

(5, 6-30)

and

P Applied axial load, lbs.

M Applied bending moment, in_-lbs.

Yc = Axial comt)ression tmock-down factor from Figure 4.2-8


dimensionless.

Note: Vor the purposes of the present ease, the quantity R (see
Figure 4.2-8) must be set equal to the equivalent radius Re which
is comt)uted as follows:

5-40
Rsmall
(5.6-31)
Re - cosa

Tb Bending lo]ock-down factor from Figxlre 4.3-2, dimensionless.

Note: For the pro'poses of the present case, the quantity R (see Fignre
4.3-2) must be set equal to the equivalent radius R e which is computed
as follows:

Rsmall (5.6-32)
Re - coset

R :: Radius at small end of cone (measured perpendicular to the


small
axis of revolution), inches.

=: Vertex tmlf-angle of cone, degrees.

The foregoing formula for P_ is based on the principles cited in Section 5.2

Since no sandwich test data are available to substantiate the recommendations made

here, they can only be regarded as a "best-available" criterion.

5.6.5.2 Design Equations and Curves

For simply supported, truncated, right-circular sandwich cones subjected to the

loading condition depicted in Figure 5.6-8, one may use the design equations and

curves of Section 5.6.4.2, except that the quantity R c must now be defined as follows:

p'
Rc = - (5.6-33)
(Pcr)Empirical

where

(5.6-34)
_,Tb/ a11

5-41
c_

_1o

_4
", :a£

c_
II

©
o
,:D
c_

r_

©
t_
%[, b d ' .

_, HIh
d

4_ _ _' D
ii_ Q_

_q
_'_ _ > r, _"

q_

_q
b

c4

_-. ,
C_O

©
I
L_

o
C_

b_
e_
©

0
tO'

5-42
0

< o
0 "_

u.,

0
:Z ._ • o:

0a

b _
Zo _

%
0
c_

b ,.--i
o _ _

.m la: _
0
D

_. o o_

01

At
11
II II

0 _
b _

/ o
0
m

V,

5-43
o
0

0
,_a
C
II
©
,Jl

¢1

E ":'1
o
r,..) 4
_1 o
'gs H
0

0 xz

, ,-..,i E
r,..)
k., ©

.fo _
o
c
j, p t_ ° ,_0
[...4
e-, ,JI -_ r--i, ..... _ _ '_
° II
o

E °

0 N _Dt"

F_ N

_ "
o ,j
r_ r_

H
r/l ,i
II
eo -_ zy
C , g C

,..t=

,,-i

-5 .2 ._
C,
2,
j m
.a
e-,
© z, ; d
I ht_
LQ

,-..i r"r" I
©
,7--,..,i _.1=

2 _ ,_..J,

5-44
r_

+
a ,_ c
g _
_ # _ .._

0
2 _o
u 4

©
b

"_ II ©

_ _ .

,_ _ • _
_g .... II

_ v
'C d'
d'
b _

__ _
Z

._._jo_ ,v _ .-, _

_7

,;'1

5-45
:4

',9
Ir rn
©

-d
°

o_
-i T
._ _.,'_
o
LJ
_ 4 _ b

r.q , ©

o
A ,-' 2
c_
'_ N0

C u ^', 2 c "_ D.21 _


<n

C_ r/,

--5
_ •
©

b_

_ m

II

r/l
>___. _?
I ° II

r/?

5 o iz 2 N e- I_' o . :,

._f
. 0

I _o -
_9
°2 O

C-

..--, © © ' > m '_

5-46
_q
,.%

i© o
o I
.,_
oo
4
• ©
o

o
o g
7
o

ba _._
c0 o $_ o
O"
o ,.c: _

© r_
mm ,'
II M bo m '_d
,4
II % + • I_ _ _,._ _ g cq

2 _i _ _*

LJ
+

,--4 r_ _ _..o
v
% o _
II g--
II
r,o o.) e_ II
T_

C3
II g .o _ 2:
N1 o

:>

d'
v1

d
r
o

5-47
+

M=

-j 2 "S,

.,% '?
o
U3

m-
.c

e_
o
_J
_d

r_

2,
E
D
Lq
C '_ +i

£,+ +f+I:
,.,Q
0 , 4 "f.

+4

,.£ _-._ Z ,_ ,.,_ ,_


+4
II
[[
o
r_
c"J

,. :.;

'B _3

fi
+ +i + -

B
B r_
0
O'3 r_
hq

I _Ju
Lm+

,.-+ +
.q
+_
+.,-3

++
_i _ ,:j

5-48
---- ...... .................

r_

C _ cO
c_ o
2o
"EI I-_ _ I:,C
0Y
_ _ _ >

o ,'_
._ _ _ ,-,
©

II

o
..-, +

c) 0 _,

e_

_ _°" s _

o "r,
_ 2
;a_ =

L_ ,al

e_
VI
_3

J_l

I
t

I c_
_ E
I

5-49
r_ _ ._

.o

o t_

t_

©
_8

4 .._ _ _ _ _

_ _ e _3e
©
_ m _ NH_
0 0

O
0

"_ ._ _. _'_o
o

g
._ °

>

_o = g

&

t_

5-51
o

II

5-52
o

5-53
o
G_

c_

O ao

0 o_
f_
oiig

_S

QJ
o I

0
o
olml

c_

o
O
c_

f_ c_
O

c_
_J o

Z
c_ ©

o_

o
c8_
c_
c_

5-54
REFERENCES

5-1 Seide, P., Weingarten, V. I. , and Morgan, E. J., "Final Report on the Devel-

opment of Design Criteria for Elastic Stability of Thin Shell Structures", STL-

TR-60-0000-19425, 31 December 1960.

5-2 Baker, E. If., "Experimental Investigatim of Sandwich Cylinders and Cones

Subjected to Axial Compression", AIAA Journal, Volume 6, No. 9, September

1968.

5-3 Seide, P., "On the Buckling of Truncated Conical Shells in Torsion", Journal

of Applied Mechanics, June 1962.

5-4 Lundquist, E. E., "Strength Tests of Thin-Walled Duralumin Cylinders in Com-

bined Transverse Shear and Bending", NACA TN 523, 1935.

5-5 Lundquist, E. E. and Burke, W. F., "Strength Tests of Thin-Walled Duralumin

Cylinders of Elliptic Section", NACA TN 527, 1935.

5-6 Gerard, G. and Becker, tt., "Handbook of Structural Stability, Part HI - Buckling

of Curved Plates and Shells", NACA TN 3783, August 1957.

5-7 Anonymous, "Test of XSM-64A Booster Fuel Tank Conical Bulkhead No. 3,"

North American Rockwell, Corp. Report No. AL-2622, 15 September 1957.

5-8 Anonymous, "Test of XSM-64.A Booster Fuel Tank Conical Bulkhead No. 4,"

North American Rockwell, Corp. Report No. AL-2623, 16 September 1957.

5-9 MacCalden, P. B. and Matthiesen, R. B., "Combination Torsion and Axial

Compression Tests of Conical Shells", AIAA Journal, February 1967.

5-10 Batdorf, S. B., Stein, M., and Schildcrout, M., "Critical Combinations of

Torsion and Direct Axial Stress for Thin-Walled Cylinders," NACA Technical

Note 1345, June 1947.

5-55
5-11
Baker, E. tt., Cappelli, A. P., Kovalevsky, L., Rish, F. L., andVerette,

R. M. , Shell Analysis Mmmal, Prepared by North American Rockwell Corp.

for the National Aeronautics and Space Administration, Manned Spacecraft

Center, [[ouston, Texas, June 1966.

5-56
6
GENERAL INSTABILITY OF DOME-SHAPED SHELLS

6.1 GENERAL

This section deals with dome-shaped shells whose contours are surfaces of revolution.

Figure 6. i--i shows the shapes considered here, all of which are truncated at the equa-

tor. Note that the torispherical shape consists of a lower toroidal segment which

blends into a spherical cap. It is expected that the configurations shown here will

cover the large majority of the dome structures likely to be encountered in aerospace

applications. One should observe that for each of

,) ,? 2 2
x y

_2 b2 Y
_...._Spheri ca 1

_---x
I.
, -

Boundary Simply- t-Boundary Simply-


Supported or
Clamped Supported or Supported or
Clamped Clamped

(b) Ellipsoidal (c) Torispherical


(a) ttemispherical

Figure 6.1-1. Structural Dome Shapes

these domes the maximum radius of curvature RMa x occurs at the apex. As a practi-

cal engineering expediency, analysis of all the illustrated configurations will be based

on this radius.

6-1
In the case of externally pressurized, thin-walled, isotropic (non-sandwich) domes, it

has long been recognized that the test results normally fall far below the predictions

from classical small-deflection theory for the axisymmelric buckling of complete

spheres. The discrepancies are usually attributed to,

a. the shape of the postbuckling equilibrium path coupled with the presence of
initial imperfections,

b. the fact that large-deflection analyses of asymmetric behavior yield criti-


cal stresses approximately 20 percent lower than the small-deflection axi-
symmetric values, and

c. the fact that classical small-deflection theory does not account for pre-
buckling discontinuity distortions in the neighborhood of the boundary.

This is analogous to the situation described earlier in this handbook (see Section 4.1)

for the case of circular cylinders. For the latter, it has become common practice to

base stability analyses and design procedures on the use of classical small-deflection

theory modified by empirical knock-down factors. This approach was selected in

Section 4.1 for sandwich cylinders and is also adopted here for sandwich domes.

6-2
6.2 EXTERNAL PRESSURE

6.2.1 Basic Principles

6.2.1.1 Theoretical Considerations

This section deals with the loading condition depicted in Figure 6.2-1. That is, a uni-

form external pressure acts over the entire surface of the sandwich dome. The net

p, psi

+
lbs l
l lbs
w j --
w -- c in
_' iI1

Figure 6.2-1. Sandwich Dome Subjected to External Pressure

vertical component of this loading is reacted by a uniform rtmning load on the boundary.

From Figure 6.1-1, note that the domes can have either simply-supported or clamped

edges. That is, during buckling the boundary is constrained such that no radial dis-

placements occur. In the simply-supported case, the shell wall is free to rotate along

the boundary whereas for clamped edges such rotations are completely suppressed. It

follows, of course, that intermediate restraints to edge rotation are also acceptable.

The theoretical basis used here is the classical, small--deflection solution by Yao [6-1]

as reformulated by Plantema [6-2]. This result embodies the following assumptions:

ao The facings are isotropie.

b. Both facings are of the same thickness.

C. Both facings have identical material properties.

6-3
d. Bending of the facings about their own middle surfaces can be neglected.

e. The core has infinite extensional stiffness in the direction normal to the
facings.

f. The eore extensional and shear stiffnesses are negligible in directions


pacallel to the facings.

g. The transverse shear properties of the core are isotropie.

R
11. The inequality 7-- >> 1 is satisfied,
C

W hc re

It _: Radius to middle surface of sandwich sphere, inches.

t = Thickness of core, inches.


C

i. Approximations equivalent to those of I)omlell TG-a] can be applied.

Strictly speaking, this solution was derived for complete sandwich spheres which

exhibit small buckles that are axisymmetric with respect to a radius of the sphere.

The development isolated one such buckle as a free body so that shallow-shell theory

could then be employed. Yao presented his results in a form which is not conducive

to a ready physical interpretation of the phenomena involved. Therefore, Plantema

undertook to ex-press the final relationships in a manner which would foster some

insight in tkis regard, tie was able to sh(rvv that, when the core has isotropie trans-

verse shear stiffness, Yao's solution is identical to the equations given earlier in this

handbook for axially compressed circular sandwich cylinders rsee Equations (4.2-27)

through (4.2-30) and Equations (4.2-4) and (4.2-5)]. TEat is, when the knock-down

factor, Y'd' is included,

(_er = 3/d Kc°'o (6.2-1)

6--4
where

_TEf h
(6.2-2)
O" o R

and

When V ---2
C

1
K = !---V (6.2-3)
c 4 e

When V >-2
C

1
K - (6.2-4)
c V
C

where

0
V (6.2-5)
C
crimp

5 2
(7 - G (6.2-6)
crimp 2 tft c c

(I = Critical compressive stress for sandwich sphere, psi.


cr

= Plasticity reduction factor, dimensionless.

= Young's modulus of facings, psi.


Ef

h = Distance between' middle surfaces of facings, inches.

v = Elastic Poisson's ratio of facings, dimensionless.


e

R = Radius to middle surface of sandwich sphere, inches.

tf = Thickness of a single facing, inches.

t = Thickness of core, inches.


C

G = Transverse shear modulus of core, psi.


C

6-5
Theequivalence
betweenanaxially compressedsandwichcylinderandanexternally

pressurizedsandwichspherehasbeenanalyticallydemonstratedonlyfor the case

wherethe two facingshaveidenticalmaterial propertiesandare of the samethickness.

If oneassumesthatthis equivalencestill holdstrue whenthe facingsare of different

thicknesses,Equations(4.2-2) through(4.2-7) canthenbe usedhereif Gxzis replaced

by Gc so that, whenthe knock-downfactor Ydis included,

o"cr = yd K c o o (6.2-7)

where

h 2_/tl_
_7o = rtEf R (6.2-8)

and

When V 22
C

1
K = 1---V (6.2-9)
c 4 c

When V '2
C

1
K - (6.2-10)
c V
C

whe re

(7
0
V - (6.2-11)
e (7
crimp

5 2
- G (6.2-12)
crimp (t 1 + t2) t c c

t and t = Thicknesses of the facings (There is no preference as to


1 2
which facing is denoted by the subscript 1 or 2.), inches.

6-6
The relationshipbetweenKe andVe canbeplottedas shownin Figure6.2-2. It is

importantto notethat the valueVc = 2.0 establishes a dividing line between two

different types of behavior. The region where Vc < 2.0 covers the so-called stiff-

core and moderately-stiff-core sandwich constructions. When V is in the neighbor-


C

hood of zero, the core transverse shear stiffness is high and the sandwich exhibits

maximum sensitivity to initial imperfections. As V increases from


e

1.0

K e

L I
2.0
Vc

Figure 6.2-2. Schematic Representation of Relationship Between K and V


e --e

zero to a value of 2.0, this sensitivity becomes progressively less. The domain

where V _ 2.0 is the so-called weak-core region where shear crimping occurs.
c

Sandwich constructions which fall within this category are not influenced by the pres-

ence of initial imperfections and a knock-down factor of unity can be applied to such

structures. It should be possible to develop a continuous transitional knock-down

relationship which recognizes the variable influence of the core rigidity but this is

beyond the scope of the present handbook.

6-7
6.2.1.2 Empirical Kmock-D(_vn
Factor

As notedin Section6.1, for the purposesof this handbook,the allowablestressesfor

externallypressurizedsandwichdomesare establishedby applyinganempirical knock-

downfactor (_d)to the results from classical small-deflectiontheory, ttowever, since


the availabletest datafrom sandwichdomeconstructionsare very scarce, onecannot

yet determineYdvalueswith a highdegreeof reliability. Theonlyusefuldataun-


coveredduringthepreparationof this handbook
are thosewhichwere obtainedby

NorthAmericanRockwelli 6-4_in conjunctionwith the SaturnS-II developmentpro-

gram. Theseresults givethe yd values shown in Figure 6.2-3 which inehides two data

points from hemispheres and six data points from domes that were approximately

ellipsoidal. Reference (;-4 includes specimens whose membrane stresses at failure

ranged all the way from the elastic to the deeply plastic zones. In three cases it was

felt that these stresses were too high to permit the computation of reliable plasticity

reduction factors. Therefore, these particular data were discarded and they do not

appear in Figure 6.2-/t. Still another experimental point was discarded because of a

faulty edge condition in the test. In addition, as noted in Figure 6.2-3, two specimens

were subjected to a thernml gradient along with the external pressure. For each of

these domes, the inner facing was at roughly +280°F while the outer facing was at

apt)roximately +10 °F. This gradient was completely neglected in the analysis per-

formed to arrive at the related Yd values. Nevertheless, these results are retained

in Figure 6.2-3 since they fall within the scatter band displayed by the other speci-

mens having the same basic contour.

6-8
1°0
i L ..... Lt • I io,
LEGEND
• ttEMISPHERES AT ROOM TEMPERATURE
,, APPROXIMATE EI_LIPSOIDS AT ROOM
TEMPE RATURE
APPROXIMATE EI, LIPSOIDS WITH TItERMAI_
0,
--[]
GRADIENT
p = SHE]_I,-WAI,I, RADIUS OF GYRATION
(p _ h/2 FOR SANDWICtt CONSTRUCTIONS i [ ' '

WtIOSE TWO FACINGS ARr._EOF EQUAL THICKNESS) I ....


0o

• ' ' ' t i i i RECOMMENDED DESIGN. '


• ' ........ . _ IVAI,UE FOR EI,I_IPSOIDS] i
_d , . .... AND TORISt tlERICAI, +

..... '' _ '•: _.. 'liiDOMES '

0o

0._

. • : ...... i ...... RECOMMENDED DESIGN


' _' '. i _' _ '.. '. i• ' _[ _"i VALUE FOR HEMISPttERES
, r ' • " " •

, I I i

0 100 200 300 400 aO0

(->)

Figure 6.2-3. Knock-Down Factor _/d for Sandwich Domes


Subjected to Uniform External Pressure

6-9
To fully understandthe informationgivenin Figure6.2-3, it is importantfor the

readerto beawareofthe datareductiontechniquesemployedhere. For anexplanation

of theseprocedures,relbrencemaybemadeto the discussionin Section4.2.1.2.1.

Althoughthat sectionis concernedwith sandwichcylinders, the samebasicapproach


wasusedin analyzingthe domes.

Basedon Figure6.2-3, it is recommended


that, exceptwhereshearcrimping occurs,

the followingvaluesma3be usedfor Td:

)'d = 0.20 for hemispheres (6.2-13)

"Yd = 0.35 for ellipsoids and torispherical domes (6.2-14)

Insufficient data are available to discern any dependence of the knock-down factor on

the ratio RMax/P. ttowever it is quite possible that even a large array of data would

lead to the same conclusion. This would be consistent with the practice usually accepted

for isotropic (non-san&rich) domes.

It is thought that there is physical justification for the hse of a 7d value for hemispheres

which is lower than that for ellipsoids and torispherical domes. This justification lies

in the fact that, for the latter two configurations, the maximum membrane stresses

occur at the apex which is well-removed from the boundary disturbances. On the other

hand, the membrane s_resses in a hemisphere are uniform over the entire surface.

Discontinuity distortions at the boundaries are ignored in classical small-deflection

stability theory but, in reality, these deformations can act somewhat like initial im-

perfections and precipitate buckling. This fact, coupled with the uniform membrane

6-10
stress in the hemisphere,canlead to earlier failure thanwouldbe encounteredfor

shapeswherethe peakmembranestressesdonot extendinto the boundaryregions.

Sincethe recommended
valuesfor Tdare basedonmeagertest results, the method

proposedhereis not very reliable andcanonlybe regardedas a "best-available"

technique. It shouldonlybeusedas a roughguidelineandfinal designsmustbe

substantiated
by test.

6-11
6.2.2 DesignEquationsandCurves

For sandwichdomesof the typesshownin Figure6.1-1 andsubjectedto uniform

externalpressure, the critical apex stresses may be computed from the relationships

given in the equations on page (;-14 where the subscripts 1 and 2 refer to the separate

facings. There is no preference as to which facing is denoted by the subscript 1 or 2.

The equations on page 6-14 were obtained by a simple extension of the formulas pre-

sented in Section 6.2.1.1. The extension was accomplished in order to cover some

situations where the two facings arc not made of the same material. This was achieved

through the use of equivalent-thiekness concepts based on the ratios of the moduli for

the respective facings. For cases where the two facings are not made of the same

material, the resulting equations are wtlid only when the behavior is elastie (r_= 1).

Application to inelastic cases (7)/1) can only be made when both facings are made of

the same material. For such configxlrations, E_ and E_, will, of course, be equal.

The buckling coefficients KC can be obtained from I"ig_rc (;.2-4.

The knock-down factor Yd may be chosen as follows:

When V 2.0 When V _ 2.0


C
e

Use ?/d :: 0.20 for hemisl)heres , Use )Jd = 1.0 for hemispheres,
ellipsoids, and torl-
USe_d _ 0.35 forellips_dds and spherical domes.
torispherical domes.

The quantity RMa x is the maximum principal radius of curvature for the dome and is

measured in units of inches. For all of the shapes shown in Figure 6.1-1, this value

occurs at the apex.

6-12
t_

[ • .

.... i':T

.!

ttL!

T T

!!

6-13
The formulations given here are based on the assumption that the transverse shear

stiffness of the core is isotropic. However, in most practical sandwich constructions,

this stiffness will vary with direction. In order to apply the given criteria to such

structures, one must select a single effective G c value. Whenever the shear crimping

modc is critical (V c : 2.0), G c must be taken equal to the minimum value for the core.

In all other cases one must rely on engineering judgment in making an appropriate

selection.

The plasticity reduction factor should always be based on the stress at the apex of the

dome. For elastic cases, use r?= 1. Whenever the behavior is inelastic, the methods

of Section 9 must be employed.

Facing 1
Facing 2

Apex a = (i {6.2-15) Apex


er 1 Yd Ke ! oi (6.2-16)
cr_ =: Yd Kcr_o_
< .:

o" = r?E 1 C (6 2-17) cr :r/E C


01 0 " (6.2-18)
% o

h 2 _ (Eztl) (Estp)
C _

o R (6.2-19)
Max

5 2

= G (6.2-20)
h _

crimp_ G (6.2-21)
C

Its+ E(_(.)t_] tc c ta+t t

(7
_ O 1 (7
o
(7 (6.2-22) V =V
(7 (6.2-23)
crimp_ C 1 C_

crimp_

6-14
Thecritical pressurePer (in units of psi) maybe computedas follows:

2 t2] (6.2-24)
Pcr - RMax ECrcrl
tl +acr2

In the specialcasewheret1= t2_tf andbothfacingsare madeofthe samematerial,

Equations(6.2-15)through(6.2-24)canbe simplifiedto the following:


(6.2-25)
Apex _cr = _d Kc(Y o

(fiEf) h
(6.2-26)
(7
O

ffe_ RMax

5 2
- G (6.2-27)
Crcrimp 2 tft c c

(7
o (6.2-28)
V - ---

e (7
c rimp

4 (6.2-29)
Pcr - R ((_crtf)
Max

6.3 OTHER LOADING CONDITIONS

No information is available concerning the general instability of dome-shaped sandwich

shells under loading conditions other than that of uniform external pressure which is

covered in Section 6.2.

6-15
r

r_
i c_

_J C,

b-, " '_ "b L_

o o _'-go
c,i H
'_@ AI

p d-' l /I,

c,_
3 _D
o
m

o -_ o

Ph _:o
0 "_ ,_
d_
b P'- ._ _._
o
U +

g._
M
0 cq lI II

;,.I, '-'

<: H ,¢

-,,11--

--0 _q

6-15
L;

2,

o
'-c

II

,-,o
b _

d_
el

0 o

_._ _ ,_ It
b

II o o

:I
li
h

rd'' o
o
p- b o @

6-17
REFERENCES

6-1 Yao, J. C., "Bucklingof Sandwich


SphereUnderNormalPressure", Journal
of the AerospaceSciences,March 1962.

6-2 Plantema,F. J., SandwichConstruction, John Wiley & Sons, Inc., New York,

Copyright 1966.

6-3 Donnell, L. H., "Stability of Thin-Walled Tubes Under Torsion", NACA

Technical Report No. 479, 1934.

6-4 Gonzalez, H. M. and Patton, R. J., "Development and Fabrication of 55-Inch

Diameter Scale Model S-II Common Bulkheads", North American Rockwell,

Corp. Report No. SDL 468, May 1964.

(_-19
7
INSTA BILITY OF SANDWI CH S HE LL SE GME N TS

7.1 CYLINDRICAL CURVED PANELS

7.1.1 Axial Compression

7.1.1.1 Basic Principles

It will be helpful here to first consider the case of axially compressed, isotropic

(non-sandwich) skin panels for which all four boundaries are simply supported. In

such cases, the Schapitz criterion _7-1] furnishes a practical means for the corn-

putation of critical stresses. This criterion accounts for the effects of skin-panel

geometry as the transition is made from wide panels, which behave essentially as

flfll cylinders, to narrow panels which approach the behavior of fiat plates. In par-

ticular, Schapitz proposed that one use the following relationships which have been

verified by the rederivation of Reference 7-2:

When
(7.1-1)

then
2
c_R
(l = U (7.1-2)
er p 4_
P

when
>2_ (7.1-3)
(YR P
then
U (7.1-4)
cr = crR

7-1
where,
(Y = Critical stress for buckling of a simply supported flat plate of the con-
P
figuration shown in Figure 7.1-1, psi.

(rfl Critical stress (in units of psi) for buckling of a simply supported complete
cylinder of radius R, length aR, and thickness t R (see Figure 7.1-1). The
quantities R, aiR, and t R are all measured in units of inches. An empirical
knock-down factor should be incorporated here to account for the detri-
mental effects from initial imperfections.

(Y, psi / a, psi

a
p

g, psi

t
P
a =a _a
R p
R
b =b ::b
R p

t =t t
R p

Figure 7.1-1. Cylindrical Panel and Associated Flat-Plate Configuration

7-2
b. For sandwichpanelswhichfall in the moderately-stiffor weak-corecate-
gories, gcr shouldbetakenequalto thehigher of the two valuesut)and(_R"

In the courseof preparingthis handbook,noanalysiswasmadeof test datafrom sand-

wich panels. Therefore,the reliability of this approachhasnot beenestablished,and,

until ex_perimental
substantiationis obtained,onecanonlyregardthe methodas a "best-

available"teebxlique.

In view of the lack of sandwichdatacomparisons,it is informativeto notethata large

collectionof test results from isotropic (non-sandwich)


specimensis evaluatedin

Reference7-3 andit is shownthere thatthe Sehapitzcriterion is a reliable approach

for suchpanels. Thetest configurationsembraceda wide rangeof , -_ , and

ratios. Narrow, wide, and intermediate panels were included. The K values fell

between those for the ease where all four boundaries are simply supported and the case

where all four boundaries are fully clamped. The results are summarized in the qual-

itative presentation of Figure 7.1-3. This figure shows the general characteristics

and relative positioning for each of the following when displayed in a nondimensional

logarithmic format :

a. The theoretical buckling relationship for fiat plates.

b. The classical, small-deflection, theoretical buckling relationship for


complete cylinders.

c. A lower-bound buckling relationship for complete cylinders. This is


obtained by multiplying the values from b; above, by the empirical
knock-down factor of Reference 7-4.

d. The design curve based on the Sehapitz criterion.

7-5
\

\
, * _ O"
er t

• .\\

% \

'\
De sign Cum'e Based
on Schapitz Criterion

Figure 7.1-3. Schematic Logarithmic Plot of Test Data for Cylindrical Isotropic
(Non-Sanchvich) Skin Panels Under Axial Compression

7-6
Althoughderivedspecificallyfor the easeof simple support,this criterion hasbeen

successfullyemployed[7-3_ wheretheboundariesprovidevariousdegreesof rotational

restraint alongwith the conditionof no radial displacement. This wasaccomplishedby

simply adjustingthe val_,efor ap to correspondwith the appropriateedgerestraints.

For the case under immediate discussion (non-sandwich skin panels), the Schapitz

criterion can be graphically represented as shown in Figure 7.1-2. A series of design

curves of this type are given in Reference 7-3. The transition curve defined by Equation

(7.1-2) becomes tangent to the full-cylinder curve when gR = 2gp. For (R/t) values

greater than that of the tangency point, the skin panel behaves as a complete cylinder.

For all other (R/t) values, the transitional relationship applies. Note that the transition

curve asymptotically approaches the line for Crp. The quantity K denoted in Figure 7.1-2

(b) = C°nstat_

Figure 7.1-2. Schematic Logarithmic Plot of Schapitz Criterion


for Non-Sandwich Cylindrical Skin Panels

7-3
is the conventionallist-plate bucldingcoefficientwhichis oh,pendent upon the aspect

ratio (a/b), 1)oundary c(mditions, and t33)e of loading. Fr,.m_ this fig-ere, it can 1)e

seen that, if the critical stress weco taken equal to the higl_er of the two values cr
P

and,7 R, one would only be neglecting the tnulsitional strenglh associated with the

cross-hatched region. When (_-_R / =: 1, neglect of this ccmtribution would restllt in a


\ P/
design value which is sl) pc, rccnt of the Schapitz prediction. For all ()/her values of the

ratio {_f{ /, the differences would be less sig_,ificanl. Indeed, for most ranges oi(;tl t
\Crp/ \ P,
the conservatism introduced hy neglecting the cross-hatched area would be quite small.

Since lhe Schapitz criterion is: dependent solely on lhe values (71) and cr R, the speculation

is nmde here that on(, might extend its application to cylindrical sandwich panels merely

by computing crp and cJt{ from the sandwich design equations and curves which are pro-

vided in Sections :; al?d .I. tfowever, in making such an extension, one inust recognize

that the behavior of a sandwich panel is dependent upon the (:ore stiffness. For stiff-

core constructions (see So.ellen 4.2), it should be possible to makt. direct application

of Equations (7.1-1) lhr_ugh {7.1-.t). On the other hand, in the weak-core region, the

sandwich panel will lail by shear crimping, and curvature will not contribute to the

buckling strength, in such cases, Equations (7.1-1) through (7.1-4) would yield uneon-

servative predictions. The situation for sandwich constructions having moderately-

stiff cores would, of course, fall somewhere between the foregoing limiting eases.

Consequently it is recommended here that,

a. For stiff-core sandwich panels, Equations (7.1-1) through (7.1-4) can be


applied.

7-4
Also sh(_vn in Figure 7.1-3 are the approximate locations of the test data fr()m the

non-sandwich cylindrical panels of References 7-5 through 7-8. During the course

of the study reported in Reference 7-3, quantitative plots were made for each of these

specimens and the corresponding test points were accurately located on the appropriate

graph. Based on these many different plots, the test points were inserted in Figure

7.1-3 in approximation to their actual positions relative to the several basic curves

and regions of behavior. This figure shows that all but four of the test points which

fall below the design curve lie within the region where the panel beltaves essentially

as a flat plate. Except for those four points, all of the test data for the regions of

transitional and full-cylinder behavior fall between the following t_vo bounds:

a. The recommended design curve.

b. The values which would have been predicted if _R did not incorporate
an empirical knock-down factor.

It is concluded that Figure 7.1-3 verifies the reliability of the Schapitz criterion

for the case of isotropic (non-san&rich) skin panels, even where the boundary con-

ditions include some rotational restraint in addition to the requirement of no radial

displacement. This conclusion is based partly on the fact that the character of flat-

plate buckling is quite different from that exhibited by wide cylindrical panels and

complete cylinders. The fiat plate can continue to support steadily increasing in-

plane loading well into the postbuckling region. This is in contrast to the sudden

drop-off in load usually observed for wide panels and full cylinders. Consequently

the Schapitz criterion utilizes full theoretical predictions as the limiting case of a

7-7
flat plate is approached. One might, therefore, expecl that within this region test data

will display some small degFee of scatter on both sides of th(, design curve, ttowever,

bucause of tile physical behavior cited above, this generally will not lead to any seFious

st ructur,,tl de fieieneies.

7-8
7.1.1.2 DesignEquationsandCurves

For cylindrical sandwichpanelssubjectedto axial compression,the critical stress

maybe computedfrom the following:


Weak-Core and Moderately-Stiff-
Core Constructions
Stiff-Core Constructions

When The higher of the two] (7.1-9)


(7. i-5) (y
cr = |values _ and gR !
[ P J

then

(_R
(3" = (7.1-6)
+ 4--_-- ' and
cr p
P

when
(7.1-7)

then
U = U (7.1-8)
cr R

whe re,

= Critical axial compressive stress (in units of psi) for the buckling of a
u
P flat sandwich plate which has the same boundary conditions as the cylindri-

cal panel and, except for curvature, is of the same geometry as the cylin-
drical panel (see Figure 7.1-1). No knock-down factor is required in com-

puting this value.

= Critical axial compressive stress (in units of psi) for the buckling of a
(;R
complete sandwich cylinder which, except for the circumferential dimen-
sion, is identical to the curved panel. An appropriate empirical knock-
down factor should be incorporated here to account for the detrimental

effects from initial imperfections.

As a rule-of-thumb, one may assume that stiff-core constructions are those which

satisfy the inequality

V <0.25 (7. i-i0)


C

where V c is computed as specified in Section 4.2.

7-9
The quantity _p should be computed by using the design equations and curves given in

Section 3.

The quantity (_R should be computed by using the design equations and curves given in

Section 4.

A graphical representation of Equations (7.1-5) through (7.1-8) is provided in Figure

7.1-4.

The method given here applies only where all four boundaries are completely restrained

against radial displacement. Therefore, no free edges are permitted. Any or all of

the four boundaries may include rotational restraint of any degree ranging all the way

from a hinged condition to fully clamped.

4.0

+ 4_-

-T.H
}--p_

3.0 4.0
(ffR/(_p)
Figure 7.1-4.
Graphical Representation of Equations (7.1-5) through (7.1-8)

7-10
7.1.2 OtherLoadingConditions

7.].2.1 BasicPrinciples

In the preparationof this handbook,almostno considerationwasgivento the buckling

of cylindrical sandwichpanelssubjectedto loadingsotherthanaxial compression.

Therefore, nofirm recommendations


canbe madehere concerningdesignequations

andcurves, llowever, the suggestionis offeredthat, for suchcases, onemight con-

sider an extensionof the conceptspresentedin Section7.1.1. Inparticular, for all

regionsof core stiffness, it mightbepossibleto applythe equation

[The higherof the two] (7.1-11)


Crcr = [values Crp and (_R J

if one simply computes the values _p and o R for the loading condition of interest.

In conformance with the restrictions of Section 7.1.1, the foregoing suggestion applies

only when all four boundaries of the panel are completely restrained against radial dis-

placement. Therefore, no free edges are permitted. Any or all of the four boundaries

may include rotational restraint of any degree ranging all the way from a hinged con-

dition to fully clamped.

7.1.2.2 Design Equations and Curves

No rcconm]endations are made here.

7.2 OTHER PANEL CONFIGURATIONS

No information is available concerning the instability of sandwich shell segments of

shapes other than the cylindrical configurations considered in Section 7.1.

7-11
©

b b

II

t, b

-<

0
Z

7-12
_L _

_ °

c_

q_

_Q

m_

r!

_o

7-13
REFERENCES

7-1 Schapitz, E., Festigkeitslehre f_r den Leichtbau, 2 Aufl., VDI-Verlag GmbtI

D_isseldorf, Copyright 1963.

7-2 Spier, E. E. and Smith, G. W., "The Sehapitz Criterion for the Elaslic Buckling

of Isotropie Simply Supported Cylindrical Skin Panels Subjected to Axial Com-

ln'ession", Contract NAS8-11181, General Dynamic Convair division Memo AS-

D-1029, 31 January 1967.

7-3 Smith, G. W., Spier, E. E., and Fossum, L. S., "The Stability of Eccentri-

cally Stiffened Circular Cylinders, Volume II - Buckling of Curved Isotropic

Skin Panels; Axial Compression", Contract NAS8-11181, General Dynamics

Convair division Report No. GDC-DDG-67-006, 20 June 1967.

7-4 Seide, P., Weingarten, V. I., and Morgan, E. J., "Final Report on the Devel-

opment of Design Criteria for Elastic Stability of Thin Shell Structures", STL-

TR-60-0000-19425, 31 December 1960.

7-5 Petcrson, J. P., Whitley, R. O., and Deaton, J. W., "Structural Behavior

and Compressive Strength of Circular Cylinders with Longitudinal Stiffening",

TN-D-1251, May 1962.

7-6 Cox, It. L. and Clenshaw, W. J., "Compression Tests on Curved Piates of

Thin Sheet Duralumin", British A.R.C. Technical Report R&M No. 1894,

November 1941.

7-7 Crate, It. and Levin, L. R., "Data on Buckling Strength of Curved Sheet in

Compression", NACA WR L-557, 1943.

7-8 Jackson, K. B. and Hall, A. H., "Curved Plates in Compression", National

Research Council of Canada Aeronautical Report AR-1, 1947.

7-15
8
EFFECTS OF CUTOUTS ON TttE GENERAL INSTABILITY OF
SAND_\rICtt SttELLS

In many practical aerospace shell structures, it is required that cutouts be incorporated

for purposes of access, lightening, venting, etc. However, no theoretical solutions or

experimental data have been published [or the general instability of sandwich shells

having such penetrations. Even in the case of isotropic (non-sandwich) shell struc-

rares, this problem tins received little attention. Some theoretical solutions have been

accomplished concerning the stress distributions around cutouts in isotropic shells

but the authors of this handbook are aware of only one paper (8-1) dealing with the

general instability problem, and this paper is not sufficiently comprehensive to pro

vide a practical design criterion.

An obvious need exists for further theoretical and experimental work to be accomplished

in this area, and, in view of this situation, no related design recommendations can be

made at the present tirne.

REFERENCE

8-1 Snyder, R. E. , "An Experimental Investigation of the Effect of Circular Cutouts

on the Buckling Strength of Circular Cylindrical Shells Loaded in Axial Com-

pression," Thesis submitted to the Graduate Faculty of the Virginia Polyteclmic

Institute in candidacy for the degTee of blaster of Science in Engineering Mechan-

ics, May 1965.


8-i
9
INELASTIC BEHAVIOR OF SANDWICH PLATES AND SItE_LLS

9.1 SINGLE LOADING CONDITIONS

9.1.1 Basic Principles

For structural members stressed beyond the proportional limit of the material, it is

customary to compute critical loads or stresses through the use of so-called plasticity

reduction factors. In this handbook, such factors are denoted by the symbol r7 • In

many cases, appropriate formulas for _7 are established by theoretical derivations

based on plasticity theory but, when this approach proves impractical, one must some-

times resort to empirical expressions. Section 9.1.2 gives the formulations for

which are recommended in this handbook for various sandwich configurations, types

of loading, and modes of instability. These equations are based on the information

provided in References 9-1 through 9-5 for isotropic (non-sandwich) plates and shells.

Application of these reduction factors involves the trial-and-error procedure outlined

below:

a. First, assume 7) = 1 and compute the critical stress for the appropriate
configuration, loading condition, and mode of failure.

b. If the critical stress computed in a, above, is less than the proportional


limit of the facing material, no further computations are required, ttow-
ever, if the computed critical stress exceeds the proportional limit, one
must continue as specified below.

c.
Assume a new value for the critical stress which is in excess of the pro-
portional limit but less than the value computed in a, above.

9-1
dp
Based on the stress level assumed in c, above, and the stress-strain curve
for the facing material, compute a value for the appropriate plasticity re-
duction factor. The formulas of Tables 9. i-1 through 9.1-3 can be used
1ol- this purpose.

_° Using lh(. r_ value computed in d above, recalculate the critical stress.

f. If the critical stress calculated in e, above, is in reasonable agreement


with the value assumed in e, no further computations are required. How-
ever, if such agreement is not aehieved, one must then repeat the eompu-
ration cycle starting with e. This iterative procedure must be continued
until acceptable agr¢_ement is attained between the assumed and the ealeu-
lated critical stlvsses.

A numerical example of the fc,regoing procedure is provided in Section 9.1.2.

9-2
9.1.2 DesignEquations

Recommended
formulasfor plasticity reductionfactors are givenin Tables9.1-1

through9.1-3 where

Ef = CompressiveYoung'smodulusof facings,psi.
E = Compressivesecantmodulusof facings, psi.
s
E = Compressivetangentmodulusof facings, psi.
t

Gf = Elastic shearmodulusof facings,psi.


G = Secantshearmodulusof facings, psi.
s
v = Elastic Poisson'sratio of facings,dimensionless.
e

v - Actual Poisson's ratio of facings, dimensionless.

Values for v can be obtained by using

v = 0.50- (0_. 50 - re) (9.1-1)

or

(9.1-2)
= o. o -\ El/

The technique for applying the plasticity reduction factors is demonstrated below by

means of a numerical example for an axially compressed sandwich cylinder which is

It is further
assumed to be of sufficient length to fall outside the short-cylinder range.

assumed that

al both facings are of the same thickness,

b. both facings are made of the same material, and

e. the transverse shear properties of the core are isotropic so that

0= (Gxz/Gyz) = 1.
9-3
For such cylinders, Section 4.2.2 specifies that the critical stress for general in-

stabilit}, may be computed [rom

(Tcr = Yc Kc(Yo (9.1-3)

where

(71E f) h
cr
o (9.1-4)

_/c is obtained from Figure 4.2-8. K e is obtained from Figure 4.2-7 where

Gr
o
V - (9.1-5)
c (Ycrimp

and

5 2

_crimp - 2tft c Gxz (9.1-6)

For the purposes of the present sample problem, assume that

Ef = i0 ×106 psi

v = 0.30
e

R = :_2.0"

h = .320"

tf = .020"

t = .300"
C

G = 20,000 psi
XZ

h
f) - 2 . 160"

R 32.0"
- - 200
p .160"

Facing Proportional Limit = 25,000 psi

9-4
By using these values and assuming that _ = 1, it is found that

7c = 0.49

cr = 104,900
0

= 170,800
crimp

V = 104,900/170,800 = .614
C

K = 0.85
C

The re fore,

gcr 7cKcCro = 49 x.85x104,900 43,600

Note that the computed critical stress (43,600 psi) is higher than the proportional limit

(25,000 psi) of the facings. Hence the use of _ = 1 cannot be valid and one must now

proceed on a trial-and-error basis. That is, one must select an assumed critical

stress value which exceeds the proportional limit. For the purposes of this sample

problem, suppose that the value (_cr = 30,000 is selected. By using the stress-strain

curve for the facing material, the corresponding plasticity reduction factor can then

be computed from the following formula which is taken from Table 9.1-3:

(9.1-7)
1--=71 Ef
Suppose that this gives the result that

= 0. 900

so that one now obtains

7c = 0.49 (remains unchanged)

= .900 ×104,900 = 94,400


O

9-5
g = 170,800 (remains unchanged)
erimt)

V = 9,t, !t00/170,800 = .553


C

K = 0.8G
e

There fore,

(rcr =YcKc cro = .49 ×.86 ×94,400 = :_9,800

Note that the eon_puted critical stress (39,800 psi) does not agree very closely with

the assumed value 1:_0,000 psi). Therefore, another iteration will be performed by

selecting a new assumed critical stress, say 35,000 psi. Suppose that by using

Equation (9.1-7) the corresponding plasticity reduction factor is found to be

r? = 0. 790

so that one now obtains

:/c = 0.,i9 (remains unchanged)

(Yo = "790 ×104,900 = 82,900

cr = 170,800 (remains unchanged)


crimp

V = 82,900/170,800 = .486
C

K = 0.87
C

"rile re fore,

cr = ,/cKcffo = .49 ×.87 ×82,900 = 35,400

Note that the computed critical stress (35,400 psi) is now in reasonable agreement

with the assumed value (35,000 psi). Therefore, no further iterations are required

and the design value for the critical stress is 35,000 psi.

9-6
=o._
"_ _ 0

_2J

L,-_ _ j
M
r_ _--

_ o

.,..4
[ i o
0

0
0
O_
..-i +

0
¢) _ 0
_o ,--_I cq 0
+
o I
,-_ I c"q
|
0
U9
r_

0
I.-..4
0
0
I I

0 I J

0 II

0 r 1

_'_ I_ _ _L
r_ 0 +
•r_ 3
'tJ
c_ +
0
I
0 o _
r..) _
0

0 r--¢
0
0

b_
I l .a
li
I
_b
N
r..)

t:_
b_
r_

,-_
0

0 [-,
©
2;

9-7
r

_I_ c'o I '._-t._

_1'_

+ IJ
_1_1
L J

_1_
f ]

i
I
1

L J L""* J
][

*3

©
r_ p q3

l i[

0 Ir
ir

,....,

c_
E_

9-8
Table 9-3. Recommended plasticity Reduction Factors for the General Instability
of Circular Sandwich Cylinders, Truncated Circular Sandwich Cones,
and Axisymmctric Sandwich Domes

PlasiicJly Heducliol_ i.'zLclol's

Mo(h:ralc l,englh
Short (:ylinders Through l,ong ('ylinders
_tnd Cones ail(I (:(rues
I

............... 1 - Lit_ Et I -u(:' _

] ,:: L,-:V ] , : L,_-77] Ef

External Laieral I)rcssure _ rl- ll_--_J Ef _4 + ,I Es)

T ors ion

Transverse Shear

ile, mispherical, Ellipsoidal, and

Torispherical Domes (All trun-


cated at the equator)

External Pressure

*This formula for r l is not valid when the cylinder or cone is so short that it
behaves essentially as a long, flat plate. However, it is unlikely that such

configuralions will be encountered in aerospace applications. Furthermore,


it is informative to note that, for such constructions, the given formula for

rl is conservative.
**This formula for rl is not valid when the cylinder or cone is so short that it
behaves essentially as a long, flat plale, ttowever, it is unlikely that such

configurations will he encountered in aerospace applications. Furthermore,


it is informative to note that, for such constructions, the given formul.a is

approximately 13-1)ercent unconscrvative.

9-9
9.2 COMBINED LOADING CONDITIONS

9.2.1 Basic Principles

As noted in llefe_'cnce 9-(;, only limited ilfformation is available on the inelastic sta-

l)ility of shell structures subjected to comt)ined loading conditions. A similar situation

exists for flat-plate constructions. Very little theoretical work has been done in these

fields due to the complexity of the problem and, in general, related phtsticity reduc-

tion criteria have not been esklblished, t[owever, in many practical engineering

applications, one is co_ffronted with this type of problem and it becomes necessary to

determine at least a rough estimate of the critical loading conditions. Toward this

end, one should note a fundamental hypothesis of plasticity theory which specifies that,

for a given material and when the stress intensity is increasing (loading condition), the

stress intensity cri is a tmiquely defined, single-valued ftmction of the strain intensity,

e i. When cri is decreasing (unloading condition), the relationship between cr i and e i

is linear as in a purely elastic case. Based on the oetahedral shear law for plane

stress conditions, the stress and strain intensities gi and c i can be defined as follows

[ 9-]] :

,. _<, a:-, _ +3r 2 (9.2-1)


1 3' xy

ei ,/,_ ¢2 _ ¢2 + ¢ ¢ +'¢:_ /4 (9.2-2)


x y x y xy

It sJ_o'_ld be noted that Eq'_tation (9.2-1) is sometimes written in ti,c following form to

facilitate its use:

[
cri (Crx)y I - 7 + )Z + 3),:: (9.2-1a)

9-10
where

cr - Normal stress in the x direction, psi.


x

Normal stress in the y dh'ection, psi.


Y

_- : Shear stress in the xy plane, psi.

- Normal strain in the x direction, in/in.


x

£ = Normal strain in the y direction, in/in.


Y

E = Shear strain in the xy plane, in/in.


xy

y x

From the foregoing discussion it can be concluded that, for the case of increasing

cy (loading condition), the relationship between (yi and e i is identical to the conven-
i

tional stress-strain curve obtained from a uniaxial loading test. It should therefore

be evident that although each individual stress component may be less than the propor-

tional limit of the material, the combination of these stresses can give a ffi value which

lies above the proportional limit so that the behavior is actually inelastic. It is im-

portant to keep this phenomenon in mind when deciding whether or not plasticity effects

must be considered.

Lacking a rigorous approach to the subject stability problem, it is conjectured here

that the foregoing generalization of the stress-strain relationship might be used in

conjunction with the plasticity reduction factor

Et
(9.2-3)

9-11
to obtain conservative predictions of inelastic instabilit%_ under combined loadings. The

quantities E t and Ef are as h)llows:

Et Tangent modulus of facing material obtained from the curve of


(_i vs e i at a prescribed value of gi' psi.

Ef Young's modulus of facing material, psi.

The above formula for _ was selected in view of its conservative nature. Since the

overall procedure suggested here is based purely on an engineering estimation, it is

thought that tttis conservatism is well justified.

The details of the suggested approach are outlined in Section 9.2.2. It is important

to keep in mind that this method does not give a rigorous solution, and its reliability

has not been evaluated by comparisons against test data. Therefore, this can only be

regarded as a "best-available" technique and one should be cautious in its application.

9-12
9.2.2 Suggested Method

The method suggested here for analysis of the inelastic stability of sandwich plates

and shells first requires that the conventional stress-strain curve for the facing ma-

terial have the stress coordinates relabeled as cYi and the strain coordinates relabeled

as e. By completely ignoring all plasticity considerations (_ = 1), one should then


1

proceed to establish a first-estimate for the critical combined stress condition. This

can be achieved by using the appropriate interaction relationships provided in earlier

sections of tiffs handbook. In performing tiffs computation, the assumption should be

made that for the critical combined stress condition the individual stress components

are in the same ratios to each other as exist for the actual applied loading condition.

That is, during loading, proportionality between the several individual stress compo-

nents is maintained. The stresses from the elastic first-estimate computation must

then be inserted into the equation

cYi = 4a; + (y2 _ cy a + 3-r 2 (9.2-4)


y xy

to determine the associated stress intensity value. If this value does not exceed the

proportio_ml limit of the cYi versus e i curve, the first-estimate stress values are in

fact the critical combination. However, if the related a i value exceeds the propor-

tional limit of the cYi versus e. curve, the first-estimate results are not valid and one

must then resort to the following trial-and-error procedure which is similar to that

outlined in Section 9.1:

a. Assume a new value for cri which is in excess of the proportional limit
for the (Yi versus e i curve.

9-13
b °
For the cri value assumed in a, above, compute the plasticity reduction
factor

(9.2-5)

who re

Et Tangent modulus of the cri versus e i curve, psi.

Ef Elastic modulus of the gi versus e i curve, psi.

co Using the 7?, value from b, above, recalculate the critical stress intensity

_.1 This is accomplished by simply multiplying the first-estimate a i value


by _.

do
If the new value for cri computed in c, above, is in reasonable agreement
with the c_i value assumed in a, above, the related plasticity reduction
factor rl is valid. Then the critical combination of stresses is obtained by
multiplying each of the first-estimate stress components by this rl value.

If the vMue of cyi computed in c, above, is not in reasonable agreement


with the cri value assumed in a, the related plasticity reduction factor is
not valid. One must then repeat the computation cycle starting with a.
This itcratlve procedure must be continued until acceptable agreement is
attained between the assumed and the computed or. values.
1

9 -14
REFERENCES

9-1 Gerard, G., "Plastic Stability Theory of Thin Shells," Journal of the Aeronautical

Sciences, April 1957.

9-2 Gerard, G. and Becker, tt., "Handbook of Structural Stability, Part I - Buckling

of Flat Plates," NACA Technical Note 3781, July 1957.

9-3 Gerard, G. and Becket, H., "Handbook of Structural Stability, Part III - Buckl-

ing of Curved PIates and Shells," NACA Technical Note 3783, August 1957.

9-4 Gerard, G., "Compressive and Torsional Buelding of Thin-Wall Cylinders in

Yield Region," NACA Technical Note 3726, August 1956.

9-5 Gerard, G., Introduction to Strueturai Stability Theory, McGraw-Hill Book

Company, Inc., 1962.

9-6 Baker, E. H., Cappelli, A. P., Kovalevsky, L., Rish, F. L., and Verette,

R. M., "Shell Analysis Manual," Prepared by North Ameriean Roe_vell, Corp.

for the National Aeronautics and Space Administration, Manned Spaceeraft

Center, Itouston, Texas, June 1966.

NASA-I.aIt!:I"v, 1969 -- 32 CR-!45_ 9-15


NATIONAL
AERONAUTICS AND SPACE ADMINISTI_ATION _

WASHINGTON, D.C. 20546


OFFICIAL BUS{NESS FIRST CLASS MAIL

POSTAGE AND FEES PAID ,

NATIONAL AERONAUTICS AN

SPACE ADMINISTRATION

If Undeliverable ( Section 158


POSTMASTER:
Postal Manual) Do Not Rettm-

"'The aeronautical and space activities of the United States rhall be


conducted so as to contribute . , to the expansion of human knowl-
edge of phenomen,t in the atmosphere and space. The Administration
shall provide ;t_r the widest practicahle and appropriate dissemhtation
o/ information concerninq its activities and the result_ thereof."

--NATIONAL AERONAUTICS AND SPACE ACT OF 1958

NASA SCIENTIFIC AND TECHNICAL PUBLICATIONS

TECHNICAL REPORTS: Scientific and TECHNICAl. TRANSLATIONS: Information


technical information considered important, published in a foreign language considered
complete, and a lasting contribution to existing to merit NASA distribution in English.
knowledge.
SPECIAl. PUBLICATIONS: Information
TECHNICAL NOTES: Information less broad derived from or of value to NASA activities.
in scope but nevertheless of importance as a Publications include conference proceedings,
contribution to existing knowledge. monographs, data compilations, handbooks,
sourcebooks, and special bibliographies.
TECHNICAL MEMORANDUMS:
Information receiving limited distribution TECHNOLOGY UTILIZATION
because of preliminary data, security classifica- PUBLICATIONS: Information on technology
tion, or other reasons. used by NASA that may be of particular
interest in commercial and other non-aerospace
CONTRACTOR REPORTS: Scientific and
applications. Publications include Tech Briefs,
technical information generated under a NASA
Technology Utilization Reports and Notes,
contract or grant and considered an important and Teehnolog, 5, Surveys.
contribution to existing knmvledge.

Details on the availability of these publications may be obtained from:

SCIENTIFIC-AND TECHNICAL INFORMATION DIVISION

NATIONAL AERONAUTICS AND SPACE ADMINISTRATION


Washington,D.C. 20546 ::
.... _ z

You might also like